Cvort 2 e

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 204

Reference No.

83130 55124

CVOR 431

Conventional VHF Omnidirectional Radio Range

Technical Manual

Part 2
Operation and Maintenance

As for details, the electrical and mechanical information given in the


documentation supplied with each equipment prevails

All rights reserved


E 2002
Thales ATM Navigation GmbH
Stuttgart
Printed in Germany
NAVAIDS
Conventional Navaids Documentation Structure

CVOR 431

The equipment documentation comprises:

Part Technical Manuals Code No.


1 Equipment Description 83130 55123
2 Operation and Maintenance 83130 55124

Volume Drawing Set Code No.


A Delivery List, Parts List, 83051 48600
Schematic diagrams and Layout Drawings
B Delivery List, Parts List, 83051 48600
Schematic diagrams and Layout Drawings

Ed. 01.02
CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Preliminary Remarks

PRELIMINARY REMARKS
The equipment manuals for CVOR 431 (50 W and 100 W, single or dual) comprise:

PART CONTENTS CODE NO.


1 Equipment Description 83130 55123
2 Operation and Maintenance 83130 55124
This Technical Manual Part 2 includes the Operation and Maintenance with the chapters below:
1 General Information
2 Installation
3 Operation
4 Alignment Procedure
Annex Alignment Procedure 8 Point Ground Check
5 Maintenance
6 Fault Location and Repairs
The 50 W and 100 W installations (single or dual) differ only slightly with respect to equipment, funcĆ
tions and operation, separate descriptions are not therefore provided for these two versions, but inĆ
stead any special features of either are pointed out. The content of part 1 "Equipment Description"
will as well-known presupposed. The 8 point ground check option is integrated in the text where it
is useful. For the alignment procedure the individual steps used for 8 PGC are described in an Annex
to Chapter 4.
Since it is not possible to include modifications, such as those which may be made to circuitry details
or dimensioning in the interests of technical progress, in the Technical Manual, we should point out
that questions of detail should always be answered using the technical documentation supplied with
the system. It is possible that reference numbers of drawings or subassemblies used in this descripĆ
tion are no longer contained in the set of drawings supplied (Volume A to C), but rather than (to conĆ
form with the system) they have been replaced by new drawings with another number. Please carry
out a once-only check on the basis of delivery list supplied and exchange where appropriate.
Description and use of the PC User Program will be found in the Technical Manual WINADRACS,
Code No. 83140 55323.
MARK SYMBOLS
To get the best out of the navigation systems Navaids 400 you should study the contents of this manuĆ
al carefully. In particular you should familiarize yourself with the marks given in this manual which are
highlighted for easy recognition:

CAUTION WARNING

Cautions call attention to methods Warnings call attention to methods,


and procedures which must be procedures or limits which must be
followed to avoid damage to followed precisely to avoid injury to
equipment. persons.

NOTE or REMARK : For more information about operations.

Ed. 01.02 A
CVOR 431
Preliminary Remarks Operation and Maintenance

Table of effective pages


Basic edition: 01.02

Pages Ed.-No. Remarks

Title 01.02

A to B 01.02
I to X 01.02
AV-1 to 14 01.02

1-1 to 12 01.02
2-1 to 50 01.02
3-1 to 16 01.02
4-1 to 38 01.02
A4-1 to 10 01.02 Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC
5-1 to 16 01.02
6-1 to 32 01.02

Trademarks: Microsoft and MS-DOS are registered trademarks, WINDOWS is a trademark of the Microsoft Corporation. IBM is a registered trademark of the International
Business Corporation. Pentium is a registered trademark of the Intel Corporation. All other mentioned product names may be trademarks of the respective
manufacturers and must be observed.

Note Despite of careful editing work technical inaccuracies and printing faults cannot be excluded in this publication. Change of text remains reserved without notification.

B Ed. 01.02
CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS
Section Title Page

CHAPTER 1 GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1


1.1 STORING AND UNPACKING THE EQUIPMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.1.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.1.2 Unpacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.2 STORING AND UNPACKING THE CVOR ANTENNA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
1.3 GENERAL INSTALLATION INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
1.3.1 Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
1.3.1.1 General Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
1.3.1.2 Precautionary Measures against Damage caused by Animals . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
1.3.1.3 Equipment Safety Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
1.3.2 Personnel Requirement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
1.3.3 Tools and Special Materials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
1.4 LIST OF RECOMMENDED INSTRUMENTS AND ACCESSORIES . . . . . . . . . 1-7

CHAPTER 2 INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1


2.1 SELECTING THE INSTALLATION SITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
2.2 VOR SHELTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
2.2.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
2.2.2 Shelter Foundation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
2.2.3 CVOR Container Shelter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
2.2.3.1 Mounting the Counterpoise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
2.2.3.2 Installation of the CVOR Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
2.2.3.3 Assembly of an Obstruction Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
2.2.3.4 Antenna Combinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13
2.2.4 Installation of the Field Monitor and Monitor Mast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
2.2.5 Installation of the Monitor Dipoles for 8 Point Ground Check Option . . . 2-15
2.3 INSTALLATION AT THE RACK IN THE SHELTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
2.3.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
2.3.2 Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
2.3.2.1 Power Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
2.3.2.2 Connection of Battery Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
2.3.3 RF-Connections at Transmitter Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
2.3.4 External Interface Connections and Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22

Ed. 01.02 I
CVOR 431
Table of Contents Operation and Maintenance

Section Title Page

2.3.4.1 DME-IDENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22


2.3.4.2 DIAGNOSIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
2.3.4.3 LGM1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
2.3.4.4 LGM2/DME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23
2.3.4.5 LGM3/NDB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23
2.3.4.6 ANALOG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
2.3.4.7 Local PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
2.3.4.8 VAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
2.3.4.9 OIO LCP IN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
2.3.4.10 OIO LCP OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
2.3.5 External Interfaces, Cable Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.3.5.1 Connection of Remote Control RMMC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.3.5.2 Connection of a local PC or Laptop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.3.5.3 Connection of Voice Signal for VAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.3.5.4 Connection of auxiliary Inputs/Outputs (LCP/CSB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.3.5.5 Connection of auxiliary Analog and Temp inputs (CSL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.4 INSTALLATION OF 8 PGC OPTION AT THE CVOR RACK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
2.4.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
2.4.2 Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
2.4.2.1 Connections at Transmitter Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31
2.5 GROUNDING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
2.5.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
2.5.2 Strip or mesh Ground Conductors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
2.5.3 Ground Rods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
2.5.4 Ground Plates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
2.5.5 Estimating the Ground Resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
2.5.6 Measuring the Ground Resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
2.6 COLLOCATION WITH DME/TACAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.6.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.6.2 Connection FSD 40/45 to CVOR 431 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.6.2.1 CSB-Version, I/O-panel at the rear of cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.6.2.2 CSB-Version, I/O-panel on top of the cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.6.2.3 IOM-Version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
2.6.2.4 Configuration of CVOR 431 and DME FSD 40/45 or TACAN FTA 43 . . . . . . . 2-40

II Ed. 01.02
CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Table of Contents
Section Title Page
2.6.3 Connection TACAN FTA 43 to CVOR 431 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
2.6.4 Connection of DME 415/435 to CVOR 431 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47
2.6.4.1 Ident and RS232 connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47
2.6.4.2 Configuration of CVOR 431 and DME 415/435 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47
2.7 INSTALLATION OF THE DME ANTENNA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50

CHAPTER 3 OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1


3.1 GENERAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
3.2 LOCAL CONTROL INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
3.2.1 Indication Lamps for Main Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
3.2.2 Liquid Crystal Display Screen for Indication and Control of the System . 3-2
3.2.2.1 General Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
3.2.2.2 Welcome Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
3.2.2.3 System Status Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
3.2.2.4 System Control Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
3.2.2.5 System DATA Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
3.2.2.6 MENU LIST Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
3.2.3 Key-lock Switch on LCP front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12
3.3 CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ON THE SUBASSEMBLIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
3.4 NORMAL OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
3.4.1 Switching On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
3.4.2 Change over from Remote to Local (on LCI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
3.4.3 Change Over to Maintenance Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
3.4.4 Change over to Monitor Bypass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
3.4.5 Acoustic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
3.4.6 Monitoring ATIS or Voice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
3.4.7 Functional Check of Indications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
3.4.8 Switching Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16

CHAPTER 4 ALIGNMENT PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1


4.1 GENERAL PREREQUISITES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
4.2 FIRST SWITCHING ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
4.3 ANTENNA ALIGNMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
4.4 RF-PHASING OF OMNIDIRECTIONAL RADIATOR LR - UR . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12
4.5 CALIBRATION OF MONITORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
4.6 SETTING OF TRANSMITTERS AND MONITORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16

Ed. 01.02 III


CVOR 431
Table of Contents Operation and Maintenance

Section Title Page

4.7 GROUND CHECK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22


4.8 SETTING OF MONITOR ALARM LIMITS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
4.9 BATTERY MONITORING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
4.10 NORMAL OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
4.11 FLIGHT-CHECK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
4.12 RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN THE MONITOR DISPLAY OF THE RF LEVEL . . 4-38
AND THE POWER

ANNEX CHAPTER 4 FIRST SETUP WITH 8 POINT GROUND CHECK OPTION . . . . . . . . . . A4-1

CHAPTER 5 MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1


5.1 GENERAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1
5.2 PERIODIC MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1
5.2.1 Elimination of Static Charges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
5.2.2 Damage check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
5.2.3 Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
5.2.4 Documentation of System Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
5.2.5 Evaluation of eight Point Ground check Measurement Results . . . . . . . . 5-3
5.3 NORMAL MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
5.3.1 Replacing the Lithium Batteries (MSP-C, MSP-VD, LCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
5.3.2 Maintaining Emergency Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
5.3.2.1 Battery Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
5.3.3 Matching the Charging Voltage of BCPS Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
5.3.3.1 Reasons for Voltage Matching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
5.3.3.2 Matching the Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
5.4 STARTUP, CARE AND MAINTENANCE OF THE LEAD BATTERY . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
5.4.1 Startup Specifications for the Lead Battery in Navigation Installations . . 5-9
5.4.1.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
5.4.1.2 Preliminary Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
5.4.1.2.1 Accumulator Acid and Specially Purified Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
5.4.1.2.2 Mixing Sulphuric Acid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
5.4.1.2.3 Relationship between the Acid Density and the Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
5.4.1.2.4 Basic Rules for Handling Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
5.4.1.2.5 Filling the Batteries with Acid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
5.4.1.3 Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
5.4.1.3.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13

IV Ed. 01.02
CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Table of Contents
Section Title Page

5.4.1.3.2 Dry Pre-charged Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13


5.4.1.3.3 Non Pre-charged Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
5.4.1.3.4 Initial Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
5.4.2 Care and Maintenance of the Lead Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15
5.4.2.1 Maintenance Accessories and Scope of Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15
5.4.2.1.1 Keeping the Lead Battery Clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16
5.4.2.1.2 Measuring the Acid Density (not for maintenance-free batteries) . . . . . . . . . 5-16
5.4.2.1.3 Topping Up the Cells (not for maintenance-free batteries) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16
5.4.2.1.4 Measuring the Cell Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16

CHAPTER 6 FAULT LOCATION AND REPAIR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1


6.1 FAULT LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.1.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.1.2 Fault Evaluation with PC and WIN ADRACS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.1.3 Fault Location Support CVOR (50 W and 100 W) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.1.3.1 Power Supply and Module Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.1.3.2 Localization of the defective Equipment Part (1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
6.1.3.3 Status Check of the Microprocessor of the MSG-C (2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
6.1.3.4 RF-Level too low or missing (3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
6.1.3.5 Modulation Depth of the Carrier is too low (4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
6.1.3.6 Modulation by Sidebands too low or wrong (5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
6.1.3.7 Wrong Carrier Frequency (6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7
6.1.3.8 Azimuth Indication (7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
6.1.3.9 Fault in the Monitor (8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
6.1.3.10 Fault of the Local Control Panel (LCP) (9) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
6.2 REPAIRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
6.2.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
6.2.1.1 Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
6.2.1.1.1 General Regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
6.2.1.1.2 Work on the Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
6.2.1.1.3 Handling Electrostatically Sensitive Subassemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
6.2.1.1.4 Components Containing Beryllium Oxide Ceramics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14
6.2.1.1.5 Handling Lead Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14
6.2.2 Correcting a Processor Standstill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
6.2.2.1 Failure in the Monitor Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15

Ed. 01.02 V
CVOR 431
Table of Contents Operation and Maintenance

Section Title Page

6.2.2.2 Failure in the Transmitter Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15


6.2.3 Replacing Subassemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
6.2.3.1 Disconnecting the Voltage before Replacing Subassemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
6.2.3.2 Subassemblies in the Transmitter Rack and Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
6.2.3.2.1 Replacing EPROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19
6.2.3.2.2 Creating new Checksum for MSP EPROM in ADRACS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19
6.2.3.2.3 Replace and Reconfigure Subassembly LCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20
6.2.3.3 CVOR Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20
6.2.4 List of DIP-FIX-Switches and Jumpers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21
6.2.4.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21

VI Ed. 01.02
CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Table of Contents

LIST OF FIGURES
Fig.-No. Title Page

Fig. 1-1 CVOR in 10 ft container shelter for all types of transport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Fig. 1-2 CVOR with packing for rail or road transport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Fig. 1-3 Packaging for rail and road transport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Fig. 1-4 Packaging for CVOR antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Fig. 2-1 CVOR siting criteria (general data) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Fig. 2-2 CVOR 10 ft shelter, foundations (informative view) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Fig. 2-3 Correct lifting with a lifting harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Fig. 2-4 10 ft CVOR container shelter, dimension and general view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Fig. 2-5 10 ft CVOR container shelter without counterpoise, inner design . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Fig. 2-6 Standard shelter, electrical installation CVOR (example) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Fig. 2-7 Assembly of counterpoise (∅ 5 m) (1 of 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Fig. 2-8 CVOR antenna in transportation crate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Fig. 2-9 Locking device at antenna base . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Fig. 2-10 Mechanical alignment of antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Fig. 2-11 Securing the CVOR antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Fig. 2-12 Mechanical alignment of the CVOR antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Fig. 2-13 Connecting diagram for CVOR antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
Fig. 2-14 Adapter for obstruction light (Ref. no. 38150 28182) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
Fig. 2-15 Adapter for CVOR antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13
Fig. 2-16 Arrangement and installation CVOR field monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
Fig. 2-17 Height position of 8 PGC monitor dipoles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
Fig. 2-18 Connections at the BCPS connection plate, C-bar and bottom plate . . . . . 2-19
Fig. 2-19 Power supply cabling: BCPS connection plate, C-bar and bottom plate, . 2-20
PMM
Fig. 2-20 CVOR Transmitter rack, top view, connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Fig. 2-21 External wiring of auxiliary OIO connectors of LCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
Fig. 2-22 Transmitter cabinet, rear side, interface connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
Fig. 2-23 CVOR transmitter rack, top view, replaced cover with additional connectors 2-31
Fig. 2-24 Transmitter cabinet, new cabling for 8 point ground check option . . . . . . . . . 2-32
Fig. 2-25 System cabling CVOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
Fig. 2-26 Different types of ground conductor configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
Fig. 2-27 Determining of the ground resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
Fig. 2-28 Interface Assignment of LGM2 and DME-Ident in CVOR 431 . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41

Ed. 01.02 VII


CVOR 431
Table of Contents Operation and Maintenance

Fig.-No. Title Page


Fig. 2-29 AF-distribution box, assignment of terminals (example) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
Fig. 2-30 CSB-Version, I/O panel at cabinet rear side, connection CVOR to DME . . . 2-42
Fig. 2-31 CSB-Version, I/O panel at cabinet rear side, ident connection . . . . . . . . . . 2-42
CVOR to DME
Fig. 2-32 CSB-Version, I/O panel at cabinet rear side, RS 232 connection . . . . . . . . 2-42
CVOR/DME
Fig. 2-33 CSB-Version, I/O panel on cabinet top, connection CVOR to DME . . . . . . . 2-43
Fig. 2-34 CSB-Version, I/O panel on cabinet top, ident connection VOR/DME . . . . . 2-43
Fig. 2-35 CSB-Version, I/O panel on cabinet top, RS 232 connection CVOR/DME . . 2-43
Fig. 2-36 IOM-Version, connector panel at cabinet rear side, connection . . . . . . . . . 2-44
CVOR to DME
Fig. 2-37 IOM-Version, connector panel at cabinet rear side, ident connection . . . . 2-44
CVOR/DME
Fig. 2-38 IOM-Version, connector panel at cabinet rear side, RS 232 connection . . 2-44
CVOR/DME
Fig. 2-39 Cable connection CVOR to TACAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Fig. 2-40 Ident connection CVOR/TACAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Fig. 2-41 RS 232-connection CVOR/TACAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Fig. 2-42 Cable connections to CVOR and DME 40/45 (DME with individual . . . . . . . 2-46
internal or external modem for RC connection)
Fig. 2-43 Cable connections to CVOR and TACAN (TACAN with individual . . . . . . . . 2-46
internal or external modem for RC connection)
Fig. 2-44 Collocation CVOR/DVOR with DME 415/435 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
Fig. 2-45 Ident connection CVOR/DVOR to DME 415/435 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
Fig. 2-46 RS232 connection CVOR/DVOR to DME 415/435 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
Fig. 2-47 Cable connections to CVOR/DVOR and DME 415/435 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-49
(DME with individual internal or external modem for RC connection)
Fig. 2-48 Arrangement and installation of the DME antenna (example AAN 96/86), . . 2-50
principle view
Fig. 3-1 Local Control Interface (LCI), example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
Fig. 3-2 Liquid crystal display screen of the Local Control Interface (LCI), example . 3-2
Fig. 3-3 Welcome window, example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Fig. 3-4 System Status window with status 'NORMAL', example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Fig. 3-5 System Status window with status 'ALARM', both transmitters are . . . . . . . . 3-5
switched off (shut down), example
Fig. 3-6 System Status window with status 'Warning', examples 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Fig. 3-7 System Status window with status 'WARNING', examples 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7

VIII Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Table of Contents
Fig.-No. Title Page
Fig. 3-8 System Status window with status 'WARNING', example 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Fig. 3-9 System Control window TRANSMITTER CONTROLS, example . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
Fig. 3-10 System Control window MONITOR CONTROLS, example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
Fig. 3-11 DATA window to indicate monitoring data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
Fig. 3-12 MENU LIST window, example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
Fig. 3-13 Data Indication window AERIAL TRANSMITTER DATA, example . . . . . . . . . . 3-12
Fig. 3-14 Key-lock switch and indication of operational mode on LCD screen, . . . . . 3-12
example
Fig. 3-15 Push buttons and indications on the subassemblies inside the rack (1) . . . . 3-14
Fig. 3-16 Push buttons and indications on the subassemblies inside the rack (2) . . . . 3-15
Fig. 4-1 Dipole slot length of CVOR antenna as a function of frequency . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
Fig. 4-2 Adjustment of the omnidirectional radiator capacitors as a function . . . . . . 4-31
of the frequency
Fig. 4-3 Alignment of circular pattern for LR and UR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
Fig. 4-4 Monitor calibration for measurement of isolation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33
Fig. 4-5 Measurement of isolation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33
Fig. 4-6 Measurement of circular pattern of omnidirectional radiators . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34
Fig. 4-7 Simulator test setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34
Fig. 4-8 Monitor Signal Simulator test setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35
Fig. 4-9 Alignment of antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
Fig. 4-10 Transmitter cabinet, rear side, potentiometers on CCP-V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37
Fig. 5-1 Accumulator acid chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
Fig. 5-2 Chart showing the relationship between the acid density and . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
the temperature
Fig. 6-1 Push buttons and indications on the subassemblies MSP and MSG-C . . 6-16
in the rack
Fig. 6-2 Preparation and adjustments during a subassembly replacement . . . . . . . . 6-18
Fig. 6-3 LCP front panel and LCP control menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20

Ed. 01.02 IX
CVOR 431
Table of Contents Operation and Maintenance

X Ed. 01.02
NAVAIDS
Conventional Navaids Abbreviations

ABKÜRZUNGSVERZEICHNIS
LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS
LISTE D'ABREVIATIONS
LISTA DE ABREVIATURAS
A
A Antenne
Antenna
Antena
AC Alternating Current
Courant alternatif
Corriente alterna
ACA Analogical Carrier Amplifier (BITE signal)
Amplificateur pour porteurs analogiques (signal BITE)
Amplificdor portador analogico (señal BITE)
ACC Alternating Current Converter
ADC Analog-Digital Converter
Convertisseur analogique/numérique
Convertidor analógico/digital
ADR Analog Display Routine
Routine affichage analogique
Rutina de indicator analógico
ADRACS Automatic Data Recording And Control System
ADSB Alternating Double Sideband
Bande latérale double alternante
Banda lateral doble alternante
AF Audio Frequency
Basse fréquence
Audiofrequencia
AFC Automatic Frequency Control
Commande automatique par fréquence
Control automático de frecuencia
AGC Automatic Gain Control
Commande automatique de gain
Control automático de ganancia
AM Amplitude Modulation
Modulation d'amplitude
Modulación de amplitud
AMP AMPlifier
Amplificateur
Amplificador
ASB Alternating SideBand
Bandes latérales alternantes
Banda lateral alternante

Ed. 01.02 AV-1


NAVAIDS
Abbreviations Conventional Navaids
ASC Antenna Switch Control
Commutateur d'antennes de commande
Control de conmutador de antena
ASCII American Standard Code for Information Interchange
Code standard américain pour l'échange d'informations
Código stándard americano para el intercambio de informaciones
ASM Antenna Switch Module
Module de commutateur d'antennes
Módulo de conmutador de antena
ASU Antenna Switching Unit
Ensemble de commutation d'antennes
Unidad de conmutación de antena
AWD Automatische Wähleinrichtung für Datenverbindungen
Automatic dialling equipment for data connections
Dispositif automatique de sélection pour liaisons d'acheminement de données
Dispositivo automático de selección para comunicaciones de datos
ATC Air Traffic Control
Contrôle du trafic aérien
Control del tráfico aéreo
B
BAZ Back-Azimuth
BCD Binär Codiert Dezimal
Binary Coded decimal
BCPS Battery Charging Power Supply
Chargeur de batterie et bloc d'alimentation
Chargador de bateria y equipo de alimentación
BD Baud
Baud
Baudio
BF Basse Fréquency
Audio Frequency
Baja frecuencia (audiofrecuencia)
BIT(E) Built-in Test (Equipment)
Dispositif de test intégré
Dispositivo de test integrado
BKZ BefehlsKennZahl
Command code number
Numéro indicatif de commande
Número indicador de orden
BSE Betriebs- und Schutzerde
System and protective ground
Prise de terre de système et terre de protection
Puesta a tierra del sistema y de protección
BSG-D Blending Signal Generator
Générateur de signaux de transition
Generador de señal de transición

AV-2 Ed. 01.02


NAVAIDS
Conventional Navaids Abbreviations
BST Baustahl
Structure steel
Acier de construction
Acero de construcción
BUSGNT Bus Grant
Autorisation de bus
Autorización de bus
BUSRQ Bus Request
Demande de bus
Solicitud de bus
C
CA Carrier Amplifier
CAB Cabinet
Armoire
Armario
CCP Control Coupler
Coupleur de commande
Acoplador de control
CDI Course Deviation Indicator
Indicateur de déviation (cap)
Indicador de desviaciòn de rumbo
CL Clearance
Clearance
Clearance
CONC Phone Concentrator
Telefon-Umschalteinrichtung
Installation de commutation téléphonique
Centralilla teléfonica
CMOS Complementary Metaloxide Semiconductor
Semi-conducteur oxyde métallique complémentaire
Semiconductor complementario de óxido metálico
CPU Central Processing Unit
Zentrale Prozessoreinheit
CR Carriage Return
Retour du chariot
Retorno de carro
CRC Cyclic Redundancy Check
CRT Cathode Ray Tube
Tube cathodique
Tubo catódico
CS Course
Cap
Rumbo
CSB Carrier signal with SideBands (HF)
Signal de porteuse avec bandes latérales
Señal de portadora con bandas laterales

Ed. 01.02 AV-3


NAVAIDS
Abbreviations Conventional Navaids
CSL Control and Selector Logic
Logique de commande et de sélection
Lógica de control y de selección
CTOL Conventional Take-off and Landing
Décollage et atterrissage classiques
Despegue y aterrizaje convencionales
CTS Clear to Send
Prêt à émettre
Listo para transmitir
CVOR Conventional VOR
D
DAC Digital/Analog Converter
Convertisseur numérique/analogique
Convertidor digital/analógico
DAS DME-based Azimuth System
Système d'azimut basé DME
Sistema de acimut basado en DME
DC Direct Current
Courant continu
Corriente continua
DCC DC-Converter
Convertisseur de courant continu (Convertisseur CC)
Convertidor de corriente continua (convertidor CC)
DCC-MV DC-Converter Multivolt
Convertisseur CC-Multivolt
Convertidor CC-Multivolt
DCC-MVD DC-Converter Multivolt Doppler
Convertisseur CC-Multivolt Doppler
Convertidor CC-Multivolt Doppler
DDM Difference in Depth of Modulation
Differenz der Modulationsgrade
Différence de taux de modulation
Diferencia de grados de modulación
DFS Deutsche Flugsicherung
Administration of air navigation services
Bureau de la sécurité aérienne
Instituto de protección de vuelo
DFT Diskrete Fourier Transformation
Discrete Fourier Transformation
DIF Differenzsignal
Difference signal
Signal différentiel
Señal diferencial

AV-4 Ed. 01.02


NAVAIDS
Conventional Navaids Abbreviations
DIN Deutsche Industrie Norm
German industrial standard
Norme industrielle allemande
Norma industrial alemana
DME Distance Measuring Equipment
Equipement de mesure de la distance
Equipo de medición de la distancia
DSB Double Sideband
Bandes latérales doubles
Banda lateral doble
DSR Data Set Ready
Enregistrement des données prêt
Registro de datos listo
DTR Data Terminal Ready
Terminal de données prêt
Terminal de datos listo
DVOR Doppler Very High Frequency Omnidirectional Radio Range
Radiophare omnidirectionnel VHF Doppler
Radiofaro omnidireccional VHF Doppler
E
ENBT Enable Bus Transfer
Validation transfert de bus
Conexión transferencia de bus
EPROM Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Mémoire à lecture seule, programmable et erasable
Memoria permanente borrable y programada
EUROCAE European Organization for Civil Aviation Electronics
Organisation européenne pour l'électronique de l'aviation civile
Organización europea para la electrónica de la aviacion civil
F
FAA Federal Aviation Administration
Administration fédérale de l'aviation
Administración federal de aviación
FET Feldeffekttransistor
Field-effect transistor
FFM Farfield Monitor
(FF)
Moniteur de champ lointain (zone Fraunhofer)
Monitor campo lejano
FIFO First In/First Out
Premier entré/premier sortie
Primera entrada/primera salida
FM Frequency Modulation
Modulation de fréquence
Modulación de frecuencia

Ed. 01.02 AV-5


NAVAIDS
Abbreviations Conventional Navaids
FPE Functional Protection Earth
Betriebsschutzerde
FSK Frequency-Shift Keying
Frequenzumtastverfahren
Manipulation par déplacement de fréquence
Método de manipulación de frecuencia
G
GS Glide Slope
Radiophare d'alignement de descente
Transmisor de trayectoria de descenso
H
HF Hochfrequenz
Radio frequency
Haute fréquence
Alta frecuencia
I
IC Integrated Circuit
Circuit intégré
Circuito integrado
ICAO International Civil Aviation Organization
Organisation de l'aviation civile internationale (OACI)
Organización de aviación civil international (OACI)
ILS Instrument Landing System
Système d'atterrissage aux instruments
Sistema de aterrizaje por instrumentos
IM Inner Marker
Radiobalise intérieure
Radiobaliza interior
INT Interface Unit
Unité d'interface
Unidad de interfase
I/O-Port Input/Output-Port
Porte d'entrée/sortie
Puerto de entrada/salida
I/Q In Phase/Quadraturphase
In-phase/Quadratur-phase
K
KADP Kabeladapter
Cable adapter
Adaptateur de cable
Adaptador de cable
L
LCC Local Communication Control

AV-6 Ed. 01.02


NAVAIDS
Conventional Navaids Abbreviations
LCCPU Local Control CPU
LCD Liquid Crystal Display
Ecran à cristaux liquides
Indicador de cristal liquido
LCI Local Control Interface
LCP Local Control Panel
LCU Local Communication Unit
LED Light Emitting Diode
Diode électroluminiscente
Diodo electroluminiscente
LF Line Feed
Avancement de ligne
Avance de línea
LGM Modembezeichnung
Modem assignation
LOC Localizer
Radiophare d'alignement de piste
Localizador
LP Leiterplatte
Printed circuit board
Plaquette à circuits imprimé
Placa de circuito impreso
LPF Low Pass Filter
Filtre passe-bas
Filtro de paso bajo
LRCI Local/Remote Communication Interface
LRU Line Replaceable Unit
LSB (1) Lower Sideband (HF DVOR)
Bandes latérales inférieures
Banda lateral inferior
LSB (2) Least Significant Bit (digital)
M
m Modulationsgrad
Mod-Depth
Taux de modulation
Profundidad (grado) de modulación
MEU Marker Extension Unit
Unité de radiobalise d'extension
Fuente de alimentación suplementaria de la radiobaliza
MIB Monitor Interface Board
Platine d'interface du moniteur
Placa enchufable de la interfase de monitor
MLS Microwave Landing System
Système d'atterrissage aux micro-ondes
Sistema de aterrizaje por microondas

Ed. 01.02 AV-7


NAVAIDS
Abbreviations Conventional Navaids
MM Middle Marker
Radiobalise médiane
Radiobaliza intermedia
MOD Modulation
Modulation
Modulación
MOD-SBB Modulator Sideband Blending (DVOR)
Modulateur de transition des bandes latérales
Modulador de transición de banda lateral
MON Monitor
Moniteur
Monitor
MOS Metallic Oxide Semiconductor
Semi-conducteur métal oxyde
Semiconductor de óxido metálico
MPS Minimum Performance Specification
Spécification de rendement minimum
Especificación de rendimiento mínimo
MPU Marker Processing Unit
Unité de marqueur de traitement
Procesador de radiobaliza
MSB Most Significant Bit
MSG Modulation Signal Generator
Générateur de signaux de modulation
Generador de señal de modulación
MSP Monitor Signal Processor
Processeur de signaux de moniteur
Procesador de señal de monitor
MSR Monitor Service Routine
Routine de service de moniteur
Rutina de servicio de monitor
MTBF Meantime between Failures
Temps moyen entre défauts
Tiempo medio entre fallos
MTTR Meantime to Repair
Temps moyen de réparation
Tiempo medio de reparacion
MUX Multiplexer
Multiplexeur
Multiplexor
MV Multivolt
N
NAVAIDS Navigation Aids
Navigationsanlagen

AV-8 Ed. 01.02


NAVAIDS
Conventional Navaids Abbreviations
Aide de navigation
Radioayudas a la navegación
NC Normally closed
Normalement fermé
Normalmente cerrado
NDB Non-Directional radio Beacon
Radiophare omnidirectional
Radiofaro omnidireccional
NF Niederfrequenz
Audio frequency
Basse fréquence
Baja frecuencia
NFK Niederfrequenzknoten (Sternverteiler)
Star distributor (for audio frequency)
NM Nautical Mile
Mile nautique
Milla náutica
NO Normally open
Normalement ouvert
Normalmente abierto
O
OAB Optocoupler Adapter Board
Platine d'adaptateur d'optcoupleur
Placa enchufable del adaptador optoacoplador
OACI = ICAO, Organisation de l'aviation civile internationale
International Civil Aviation Organization
Organización de aviación civil international
OM Outer Marker
Radiobalise extérieure
Radiobaliza exterior
P
PC Personal Computer
PCB Printed Circuit Board
Carte à circuit imprimé
Tarjeta de circuito impreso
PDME Precision DME
DME de précision
DME de precición
PE Protection Earth
PEP Spitzenleistung
Peak envelope power
Puissance de pointe
Potencia punta

Ed. 01.02 AV-9


NAVAIDS
Abbreviations Conventional Navaids
8 PGC Eight Point Ground Check
Acht Punkt Test Bodenfehlerkurve
PLL Phase Locked Loop
Boucle à verrouillage de phase
Bucle de bloqueo de fase
PMC Phase Monitor and Control
Moniteur de phase et commande
Monitor de fase y control
PMDT Portable Maintenance Data Terminal
PMM Power Management Module
POP Power on Parallel
POSN. Position Course
Position de cap
Posición de rumbo
PROM Programmable Read Only Memory
Mémoire à lecture seule et programmable
Memoria permanente programada
PRUM Protector Unit Marker
Radiobalise d'unité de protection
Unidad de protección de la radiobaliza
PRUT Protector Unit Tower
Unité de protection
Unidad de protección
PS Power Supply
Bloc d'alimentation
Equipo de alimentación
PSI Power Supply Interface
Interface du bloc d'alimentation
Interfase equipo de alimentación
PSS Power Supply Switch
Interrupteur de puissance
Interruptor de alimentación
PSN Position
Position
Posición
PVC Polyvinylchlorid
Polyvinyl chloride
Chlorure de polyvinyl (C.P.V.)
Chloruro de polivinilo
PWR Password Routine
Routimne de mot de passe
Rutina de contrasena

AV-10 Ed. 01.02


NAVAIDS
Conventional Navaids Abbreviations
R
RAM Random Access Memory
Mémoire à accés aléatoire
Memoria de acceso aleatorio
RC Remote Control
Télécommande
Control remoto
RCMS Remote Control Monitoring System
Système de télécommande et de surveillance
Sistema de control y monitoreo remotos
RCSR Remote Control Service Routine
Routine de service de télécommande
Rutina de servicio de control remoto
RCSU Remote Control Status Unit
REU Remote Electronic Unit
RF Radio Frequency
Haute fréquence (HF)
Radiofrecuencia
RIA Remote Interface Adapter
Adaptateur d'interface de télécommande
Adaptador de interfase telemando
RIAX Remote Interface Adapter extended
Adaptateur d'interface de télécommande étendé
Adaptador suplementario de interfase telemando
RMMC Remote Monitoring and Maintenance Configuration
ROM Read Only Memory
Mémoire à lecture seule
Memoria permanente
RST Restart
Remettre en marche
Nueva puesta en marche
RTCR Real Time Clock Routine
Routine de rythme en temps réel
Rutina de reloj en tiempo real
RTS Request to send
Marche l'émetteur
Activación del transmisor
RX Receiver
Récepteur
Receptor
RXC Receiver Clock
Rythme du récepteur
Reloj de receptor

Ed. 01.02 AV-11


NAVAIDS
Abbreviations Conventional Navaids
RXD Receiver Data
Données de récepteur
Datos de receptor
RXRDY Receiver Ready
Récepteur prêt
Receptor listo
S
S Switch
Commutateur
Conmutador
SB Sideband
Bandes latérales
Banda lateral
SB1, SB2 Sideband 1, Sideband 2
Bandes latérales 1, 2
Banda lateral 1, 2
SBA Sideband A (used in VOR)
Bandes latérales A (utilizé en VOR)
Banda lateral A (utilizado para VOR)
SBB Sideband B (used in VOR)
Bandes latérales B (utilizé en VOR)
Banda lateral B (utilizado para VOR)
SBO Sideband Only
Bandes latérales seulement
Banda lateral solamente
SBR Subrack
Sous-bâti
Subrack (con junto)
SCC Serial Communication Controller
SDM Sum of Depths of Modulation
Somme des taux de modulation
Suma de grado de modulación
SPDT Single Pole Double Throw
Commutateur unipolaire
Conmutador unipolar doble
SP3T Single Pole 3 Throw
Commutateur unipolaire triple
Conmutador unipolar triple
STOL Short Take-Off and Landing
Système de décollage et d'atterissage court
Despegue y aterrizaje corto

AV-12 Ed. 01.02


NAVAIDS
Conventional Navaids Abbreviations
SUM Summensignal
Summation Signal
Signal de la somme
Señal de suma
SYN Synchronisation
Synchronisation
Sincronización
SYN Synthesizer
T
TACAN Tactical Air Navigation
Navigation aérienne tactique
Navigación aérea táctica
TEG Test Generator
Générateur de test
Generador de test
TOR Time Out Routine
Routine de temps de suspension
Rutina de tiempo de suspensión
TTL Transistor-Transistor Logic
Logique transistor-transistor
Lógica transistor - transistor
TX Transmitter
Emetteur
Transmisor
TXC Transmitter Clock
Rythme d'émetteur
Reloj de transmisor
TXD Transmitter Data
Données d'émetteur
Datos de transmisor
TXRDY Transmitter Ready
Emetteur prêt
Transmisor listo
U
USART Universal Synchronous/Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
Récepteur/émetteur universel synchrone/asynchrone
Receptor/transmisor universal síncrono/asíncrono
USB Upper Sideband (HF DVOR)
Bandes latérales supérieures
Banda lateral superior
V
VAM Voice Amplifier
Amplificateur vocal
Amplificador vocal

Ed. 01.02 AV-13


NAVAIDS
Abbreviations Conventional Navaids
VCO Voltage Controlled Oscillator
VHF Very High Frequency
Hyperfréquence
Hiperfrecuencia
VOR Very High Frequency Omnidirectional Radio Range
Radiophare omnidirectionnel VHF
Radiofaro omnidireccional VHF
VSWR Voltage Standing Wave Ratio
Taux d'ondulation
Grado de ondulación
VTOL Vertical Take-off and Landing
Décollage et atterrissage verticaux
Despegue y aterrizaje vertical
W
WT Wechselstrom-Telegrafie
Voice-frequency carrier telegraphy
Télégraphie harmonique à ondes porteuses
Telegrafía armónica
Z
ZU Zeichenumsetzer
Modem for data transfer
Convertisseur de signaux
Convertidor de señal

AV-14 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance General Information

CHAPTER 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.1 STORING AND UNPACKING THE EQUIPMENT
1.1.1 General
The equipment should be unpacked as soon as possible in order to check that it is complete and
intact. The place of storage used for any intermediate storage period must be dry. The temperature
range specified in the technical data in Part 1 must be conformed with. The table below is an example
of the type of packing.
PackĆ Contents Ref. No. Dimensions with Gross
age packaging (mm) weight (kg)
1 1 Shelter including: 3000 x 2440 x 2440 1,900
cabinet CVOR (equipped):
- 50 W dual or single or 83011 40100 / 40150
- 100 W dual or single 83011 40200 / 40250

enclosed: 1 Matching Device 58317 24013

Documentation CVOR
2 1 CVOR antenna 83131 72401 3500 x 1100 x 1300 500
2,400

Fig. 1-1 CVOR in 10 ft container shelter for all types of transport

PackĆ Contents Ref. No. Dimensions with Gross


age packaging (mm) weight (kg)
1 1 Cabinet CVOR (equipped) 1940 x 830 x 880* approx. 279
1980 x 880 x 890** approx. 323
- 50 W dual or single or 83011 40100 / 40150
- 100 W dual or single 83011 40200 / 40250
2 Documentation CVOR
3 1 CVOR antenna 83131 72401 3500 x 1100 x 1300 approx. 500
* Corrugated paper container ** wooden crate

Fig. 1-2 CVOR with packing for rail or road transport

1.1.2 Unpacking
The equipment and components are also packed in wooden crates for transport by sea. These woodĆ
en crates should always be deposited with the side marked "Oben" (Top) facing upwards.
- Open the lid of these crates using a hammer and nail puller. Remove the filler. Remove the equipĆ
ment in the plastic sheeting horizontally, and lay it down so that the side marked "Oben" faces upĆ
wards. Cut open the plastic sheet and remove the equipment.

CAUTION

The packaging with the transmitter cabinet (Fig. 1-3) should always be laid down so that
the pallet (Fig. 1-3/4) is at the bottom. In addition arrows and inscriptions painted on the
crate indicate the side which must face upwards.

Ed. 01.02 1-1


CVOR 431
General Information Operation and Maintenance
- Cut through the three plastic ribbons (Fig. 1-3/2) with scissors and remove. Lift off the telescope
box (Fig. 1-3/1), 2 people required. Remove the foam panel (Fig. 1-3/8). Carefully lift the
transmitter cabinet (Fig. 1-3/6), 2 people required, and install in a vertical position.

WARNING

Hold the transmitter cabinet firmly in position until the support angles (Fig. 1-3/3 and 5)
have been dismantled. Pay special attention when removing the lower support angle.

- Undo the two screws (M10) left and right on the upper support angles (Fig. 1-3/5). Remove the
screws and washers and the upper support angles left and right. Tilt the transmitter cabinet (Fig.
1-3/6) forward slightly, hold it and dismantle the lower support angle (Fig. 1-3/3). Then carry the
transmitter cabinet to its point of installation and screw to the floor.
- Open the front door and remove the foam panel behind it.
- Close the front door.

Store away all despatch packaging (Fig. 1-3), so that it can be used again for transport purposes
if required. Use the original packaging components to repack. Repack the equipment and subassemĆ
blies as described above, but in reverse sequence.

ÂÂÂ 3

ÂÂÂ
ÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄ
1 Telescope box
5 ÂÂÂ
ÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄ
ÂÂÂ
ÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄ
2 Plastic ribbon
ÄÄÄÄÄ
ÂÂÂ
ÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄ 4

ÄÄ
Ä
ÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄ
3 lower support angle
(ref. no. 36480 28009)

ÄÄÄÄÄ
ÄÂÂ
ÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄ
4 Pallet
5 upper support angle (2x)

6
7
(ref. no. 36385 28026)
Transmitter cabinet
Foam panel
ÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄÄ
Fig. 1-3 Packaging for rail and road transport

1-2 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance General Information
1.2 STORING AND UNPACKING THE CVOR ANTENNA

The CVOR antenna is supplied in a crate with dimensions approx. 3500 x 1300 x 1100 [mm].

CAUTION

This crate is not suitable for stacking, and should not be subjected to any load. The crane
driver must be instructed that it is essential to pull the lifting cable under the pallet. The
crate may be transported using the fork lift truck, because the pallet has been designed
accordingly.

If intermediate storage is necessary, the crate or the unpacked antenna should be stored in a dry
room. It is advisable to check the intactness of the antenna immediately after it is received. An unĆ
packed antenna should always be stored on the pallet.

loosen and remove


5 parts with crowbar

approx.
1300 mm

pallet = carrying surface

approx. 3500 mm
plastic sheeting stapled
to the wooden section

remove wooden clamps

Fig. 1-4 Packaging for CVOR antenna

The antenna should be unpacked with care. On no account should the crate be forced open with a
hammer. A crowbar (nail puller) should be used to remove the nails and loosen the side sections. The
pallet, the lid and the side panels should be preserved for transport at a later date. After removing the
crate sections remove the plastic sheeting 3 m x 5 m. This too should be stored for use at a later date.
The ends of the antenna are secured with two wooden clamps for protection during transport. ReĆ
move these wooden clamps.

CAUTION

The antenna may only be lifted at the ends. Four persons should carry it. Weight of antenĆ
na: With crate 495 kg, without crate 115 kg.
If no fork lift truck is available, the antenna should be unloaded on delivery such that the distance over
which the unpacked antenna is transported is as short as possible.

Ed. 01.02 1-3


CVOR 431
General Information Operation and Maintenance

1.3 GENERAL INSTALLATION INFORMATION


1.3.1 Safety Precautions
It is the task of the site supervisor or construction manager to make available the materials supplied
by Thales ATM, independently procured special materials and tools. For every site strict attention
should be paid to safety regulations issued by the local authorities.
1.3.1.1 General Rules
The following rules should be observed for prevention of accidents:
- Consumption of alcohol in any form is forbidden on the installation site.
- Drunken persons, or those under influence of alcohol will not be tolerated on the installation site.
- Protective goggles and safety gloves are to be worn when work is being carried out on batteries.
Rinsing water, soda and several cleaning cloths should be available.
- Sturdy shoes, safety gloves and safety helmets are to be worn. Safety belts with rescue line and
carbine swivel have to be used working on the counterpoise platform.
- Protruding nails, strips etc. must be removed immediately. Ladders and planks must always be
carefully checked before use.
- Do not tread on protruding plank sections.
- Never leave objects on scaffolding or ladders.
- Scaffolding or frames are to be erected sturdily and must always be tested before use.
- Test electrical devices and extension cables for accident safety.
- Remove fuses before carrying out work on mains.
- Wear protective goggles when carrying out sanding or drilling operations.
- Sand off burr from chisels and punches in good time.
- Test striking tools for tightness of fit.
- Do not put pointed or sharp objects into working-clothing pockets.
- Jewelry such as chains and rings should be removed when working on building sites -
especially when working with electrical devices.
- Always keep escape routes clear.
- Every employee on an installation site should know:
S where the First-Aid box is kept
S the telephone number of the nearest casualty doctor and eye specialist
S where the fire extinguisher is kept
S the location of hazardous areas on the way to the work place, or at the work place itself.
1.3.1.2 Precautionary Measures against Damage caused by Animals

Damage caused by animals is highly improbable. The door should be locked in the absence of the
personnel. During installation and maintenance period it is absolutely essential that the radome reĆ
mains closed overnight as well as during work breaks in the daytime. Otherwise it is likely that birds
will build their nests inside the radome.

1.3.1.3 Equipment Safety Notes


Subassemblies should not be removed whilst under voltage. The consequence of this type of action
is the likelihood of permanent damage and the transmitter cabinet can not be set in operation corĆ
rectly.
Never energize the installation with a non-grounded rack. The first electrical connection to be made
should be the rack ground. If there is no ground, the equipment central processing unit may develop
a fault or become blocked.

1-4 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance General Information
1.3.2 Personnel Requirement

At least 4 persons are required to install the shelter. In addition to the crane driver, at least two further
persons are required to install the antenna on the counterpoise. It is however advisable to keep four
persons ready for all installation work, so that a standby is available in case of unforeseen events.
If the antenna is lifted onto the shelter roof using improvised means and without a crane truck, then
four persons are absolutely essential, and a fifth person would simplify operations.

1.3.3 Tools and Special Materials


The delivery list provided by Thales ATM should be checked at as early a date as possible in order
to identify materials not included in Thales ATM's scope of delivery which may be essential for the
infrastructure of the overall installation. For example, materials for grounding the CVOR installation
must be provided. Suggestions and instructions on correct grounding are contained in Chapter 2.
The following tools and equipment are the minimum required to unpack and assemble the equipment
and the antenna system (not including the DME or the TACAN):

1 crane truck, lifting capacity  500 kg, min. jib reach 3 m, lifting height approx. 7 m;
alternatively a 10 to 12 m long guyed auxiliary mast with block and tackle can be used
(see also installation of CVOR antenna)
1 crowbar
1 hammer 1000 g
2 ratchets with sets of sockets
1 three-square scraper
1 inch ruler
1 spirit level
1 impact drill, min. power 600 W
1 set screwdrivers, blade width 3.5 mm to 8 mm

various flat and round files


various carbide drills
various twist drills for metal

Ed. 01.02 1-5


CVOR 431
General Information Operation and Maintenance

1-6 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance General Information
1.4 LIST OF RECOMMENDED INSTRUMENTS AND ACCESSORIES

The following list contains recommendations for instruments, cables, attenuators, adapters and other
accessories, which may be used for installation, maintenance and trouble shooting of navigation
equipment, or at least will make the work easier. This equipment (or that with comparable characterisĆ
tics) is normally present at the site. If not, it can be supplied optionally by Thales ATM. A selection
of necessary equipment and accessories to be provided can be defined in consultation with Thales
ATM.

For the appropriate works, e.g. for startup, the necessary equipment is mentioned in the chapters
concerned.

Ed. 01.02 1-7


CVOR 431
General Information Operation and Maintenance

1-8 Ed. 01.02


ILS VOR DVOR Marker

Ed. 01.02
Designation Code No . Remarks/Type

Digitalmultimeter 97991 28480 Fluke 85 x x x


Dual trace oscilloscope 97991 28454 TDS 360 x x x x
HF power meter 97991 28040 43, Bird, TNC-fem. x x x x
Monitor dipole, portable 58317 24019 x
Dipole 60 cm 38826 28006 x
Mon. dipole add. parts mobile 83131 72409 x
Operation and Maintenance

Tripod 19614 72801 G5K, No. 1151 x


VOR-Monitor signal simulator 83134 31600 x
ILS/VOR signal analyzer 97991 28447 7010 portable x x
Attenuator 100 W/30 dB 50 W 49901 28051 50 W / RBU100.8654.37 x
Probe 19983 15001 x

Measuring element 50 W 97991 28043 50 C, Bird x x x


Measuring element 25 W 97991 28111 25 D, Bird x
Measuring element 10 W 97980 28193 10 C, Bird, 100...250 MHz x x
Measuring element 5 W 97991 28112 5 D, Bird x
Measuring element 1 W 97991 28192 095-1, Bird x x x
Measuring element 1 W 97991 28193 275-1, Bird x
Measuring element 5 W 97991 28041 5 C, Bird x x
Measuring element 100 W 97991 28181 100 C, Bird x x

Directional coupler 97991 28273 HP 778 D x x x


Terminatingresistor 97991 28274 HP 8491 A, 30 dB, opt. 30 x x x
Attenuator 100 W/30 dB 97499 28007 BN 745395 x x x
3-dB-coupler 49901 23002 CH-132 x x x
VHF-dummy load 50 W 24338 20404 R404 632 TNC, Radiall x
VHF-dummy load 1 W 24338 20401 BN753790 / 50 W x
General Information

1-9
x = available (optional)
CVOR 431
ILS VOR DVOR Marker

1-10
Designation Code No. Remarks/Type

Dummy load 12 W 24338 28015 R404561 TNC x x x x


CVOR 431

Attenuator 20 dB/3,5 W 49901 20402 50 W, BN654104 x x x


Attenuator 10 dB/1 W 49901 20405 50 W, R414510 TNC x x x
General Information

Attenuator 6 dB/1 W 49901 20403 50 W, R414506 TNC x x x


Attenuator 20 dB/1 W 49901 20406 50 W, R414520 TNC x x x
Attenuator 3 dB/7 W 49901 23001 50 W, BN654100 x x x x
Attenuator 10 dB/10 W 49901 28044 50 W, BN745383 x -

Adapter 24334 20323 TNC-male/fem.BN150419 x x x


Adapter 24334 20342 TNC-male/maleBN746700 x x x
Adapter 24334 20403 TNC-fem./fem.BN746600 x x x
Adapter 24334 20404 BNC-male/banana pin SHU06996 x x x
Adapter 24334 20408 BNC-male/TNC-fem.BN712100 x x x
Adapter 24334 20409 TNC-male/N-fem.BN725900 x x x
Adapter 24334 20412 TNC-fem./N-male BN 725800 x x x
Angle adapter 24334 20413 N V/M BN299700 x x x
Adapter 24334 28017 SMA-male/TNC-fem.BN150907 x x x
Adapter 24334 28018 SMA-fem./TNC-maleBN150908 x x x

RF-cable, 0,5 m 24029 28051 TNC-male/male x x x


RF-cable, 2 m 24029 28052 TNC-male/male x x x
RF-cable, 2 m 24029 28207 BNC-male/male x x x

Ed. 01.02
x = available (optional)
Operation and Maintenance
ILS VOR DVOR Marker

Designation Code No. Remarks/Type

Ed. 01.02
RF-cable, 55°/113 MHz 27288 03859 TNC-male/fem. x
RF-cable, 30 m 24029 28062 TNC-male/maleBN201961 x x
RF-cable, 0,08 m 24029 28185 TNC-male/fem., 50 Ohm x x
RF-cable, 0,60 m 24029 28187 TNC-male/fem., 50 Ohm x x x
RF-cable, 0,40 m 24029 28373 N-male/TNC-male, 50 Ohm x x x
RF-cable 27288 03856 SMA/TNC x
RF-cable 27288 03886 SMA-N RG400 x
Operation and Maintenance

AF-cable, 3 m 24029 28218 Banana pin/banana pin, shielded x x x


AF-cable 24039 28136 ∅ 2.52 , 300 mm yellow/green x
AF-cable 24039 28137 ∅ 2.52 , 520 mm yellow/green x
AF-cable 24039 28138 ∅ 2.52 , 520 mm blue x
AF-cable 24039 28139 ∅ 2.52 , 520 mm brown x

Coaxial adapter 97243 21318 BNC-fem./TNC-fem.BN712300 x x x


Coaxial adapter 97243 21319 BNC-fem./TNC-maleBN712000 x x x
Coaxial adapter 97243 21320 BNC-male/BNC-maleBN591700 x x x
Coaxial adapter 97243 21321 BNC-fem./N-maleBN999400 x x x
Coaxial adapter 97243 21322 TNC-fem./N-fem.BN726000 x x x
Coaxial adapter 97243 21323 SMA/TNC-fem.BN150906 x x x
Coaxial adapter 97243 21324 SMA/BNC-fem.BN640802 x x x
Coaxial adapter 97243 21325 SMA-male/BNC-fem.BN640800 x x x

Test prod 24387 28001 Type 930-113-100, Hirschmann x x x

Others (Used for battery charging/maintenance):

Acid syringe with areometer


Acid jug
Funnel
Container (non-metallic) with distilled water
Cleaning agent (vaseline, soda, waste wool)
General Information

x = available (optional)

1-11
CVOR 431
CVOR 431
General Information Operation and Maintenance

1-12 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation

CHAPTER 2
INSTALLATION
2.1 SELECTING THE INSTALLATION SITE

The area in which a CVOR is to be installed is determined by the responsible Civil Aviation Authority
according to the international air traffic regulations. This area is generally sufficiently large to allow
a point with the optimum topography and thus the optimum propagation conditions to be choosen.
This point is determined by means of a site survey at which a surveyor must always be present. Thales
ATM can provide an engineering consultant on site for this survey. When the installation site has been
determined precise bearings must be taken, either with reference to trigonometrical points or - if a
satellite receiver is available - via satellite radio for increased precision.

Individual tree with height up to 12 m


Group of trees
Telephone lines
Buildings with metallic content 2,5°

Radial power lines up to 10 kV



Shrubbery, wire fences up to 1.20 m Power lines <10 kV
Sheds, individual trees with heights 7 m if horizontal spread <10°
1,5°

CVOR Station 1° Dense forest.


Buildings with metallic content
0,5°
Metallic buildings (hangars)
type h = 3 m

65 m
250 m
terrain slope 400 m
terrain slope
<2,3% terrain slope 600 m
<4%
<8%
terrain slope not specified

TOP VIEW

ÄÄÄÄ
flat, obstacle free r250 m r400 m
terrain

ÄÄÄÄ
r600 m
r65 m

ÄÄÄÄ
ÄÄÄÄ group of trees
h<12 m

ÄÄÄÄ
<7°

wire fences h<7 m


h<1,2 m
h<10 m forest
no metallic <10°
h<13 m
objects
metallic buildings

power lines h<7 m

h<8 m
power lines h<10 m

Fig. 2-1 CVOR siting criteria (general data)

Ed. 01.02 2-1


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2.2 VOR SHELTER


2.2.1 General
The following type of shelter is available to build up an CVOR installation:
- 10 ft CVOR container shelter Ref. No. 83134 60010
An adaptation plate ref. no. 35980 28001 is available for adaptation to existing shelter/buildings.

2.2.2 Shelter Foundation


The following drawing shows the foundations for the standard 10 ft shelter which is used in a modified
version for a CVOR Installation. The drawings are for information only.

1 2 15
3
4
15
15
22,5

25

min. 10
48
door 5 *)
279
ÉÉ
ÇÇÇÇ
ÉÉ
ÉÉ
ÇÇÇÇ
ÉÉ
35

6
min. 100

ÉÉ
ÇÇÇÇ
ÉÉ
249

ÉÉ
ÇÇÇÇ
ÉÉ
8

A ÉÉ
ÇÇÇÇ
ÉÉ 9

View A-A
90° rotated
50

5 *)

A 50

NOTE:
- Dimensions in cm
- Concrete quality B25

1 Tube for data, signal and monitor cable Optional


2 Tube for mains voltage supply cable 7 Bitumen coating (Nitroprime-10)
3 Tubes diameter 100 mm ∅ each 8 Damp proof course (min. 150 µm)
4 Arrangement for cable entry through the shelter floor 9 Stone bedding (Layer height approx. 150 mm)
5 Recess (4x) only for use of rag bolts
*) ommitted for shelter fixing with anchor rods
6 selected filling, 100 % compressed

Fig. 2-2 CVOR 10 ft shelter, foundations (informative view)

2-2 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.2.3 CVOR Container Shelter
See Figs. 2-3 to 2-6.
The Navaids equipment can be supplied already installed in a 10 ft Standard Shelter (type 1D) which
is offered by Thales ATM. To cover the requirements the shelter is based on the definition on transport
containers ISO/DIN standards. The shelter consists of a self-supporting, distortion resistant steel
frame construction with eight ISO corners and walls made of sandwich panels in standardized conĆ
tainer dimensions.

WARNING

Sturdy shoes, safety gloves and safety helmets are to be worn during installation. Safety
belts with rescue line and carbine swivel have to be used working on the counterpoise
platform. Avoid walking on the counterpoise outer parts during antenna installation.

During installation, the shelter should be placed on the foundations such that the door is oriented
according to the site survey and project drawings. The shelter is anchored to the four foundation
blocks using the ISO corners and twist locks. The power supply (mains) and signal (RC, field monitor)
feeder cables enter from below through openings in the shelter floor.

NOTE: When installing the antenna it should be remembered that the roof of the shelter may be
mounted by two persons max., though the lateral counterpoise sections should not be
used as a working surface.

No risk is involved if these sections are mounted briefly occasionally, providing all supĆ
ports are fitted correctly.

A completely flat, electrically homogeneous counterpoise surface, which remains stable


in windy conditions, is essential for the quality of the radiated signal. A check should be
performed following installation to ensure that the surface of the counterpoise has no unĆ
even points higher than 5 mm or cracks longer than 50 mm.

When transporting the shelter by crane or helicopter, care should be taken to ensure that the angle
between the lifting harness and the crate is at least 60° (see Fig. 2-3).

min. 60°

Fig. 2-3 Correct lifting with a lifting harness

Ed. 01.02 2-3


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance
counterpoise
Support for A/C
5000 diameter

2554

2438
2991 2438
(Dimensions in mm; Tare weight approx. 900 kg, without counterpoise)

CVOR antenna radome

mounting for CVOR antenna


counterpoise (diameter 5 m)

Air Conditioner

supports for lateral parts


of the counterpoise

Lead through used


for DVOR antenna 10 ft Container Shelter
connections

Ventilation of battery box

Fig. 2-4 10 ft CVOR container shelter, dimension and general view

2-4 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation

mounting hole for CVOR antenna Matching Device CVOR


Location

Â
Â
Concrete foundation
Location of cabinets
cable feed opening (CVOR, DME, TACAN)

Battery Box

Fig. 2-5 10 ft CVOR container shelter without counterpoise, inner design


Wiring Diagram of electrical Installation * Example diagram for Mains Supply with 3 Phases, , N and PE

option box
Main Fuse Main Distribution Panel
switch
L1 *
L2

L3
Residual
Current Breaker
N 40
a I>
0.03
FI1
B2A

B10A B18A C20A C20A C20A C20A


B10A
B10A

F4 F3 F1 F2 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9
PE
change o.
Overvoltage
Protection
4 3 1 Spare 2 5 6 7 8 9 10
optional
..
optional

BCPS θ junction box


.... +
DME

- 48 V set to
.... DME A/C1 A/C2 36 °C
heater

.... TX
Temp.
Earth Collector Bar

BCPS if available
TX Rack
Sensor
DME
Inside Light Socket outlets Air-Conditioner
etc.
Single Phase "Option"
F2 (G0.2A)
F1 (K50A)

20 protected wires

- -
Station Ground

+
twilight obstruction light
Signal lines 90 V/Type F
Emergency battery switch antenna
NF 600 OHM 48 V
Line Terminal Box

Fig. 2-6 Standard shelter, electrical installation CVOR (example)

Ed. 01.02 2-5


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2.2.3.1 Mounting the Counterpoise

   A,B,C 14,11
44

22,23,27

Ă 5

counterpoise

eye bolt

warning sign
ACCESS PROHIBITED

outer part outer part

pivot to hang outer parts


(assembly aid)

center part
5 support 22 hex. nut 44 eye bolt
6 angle 23 spring washer
9 clamp 25 hex. screw
10 contact plate 26 spring washer
11 cover 27 hex. screw
14 L ring 28 spring washer
15 fittings 29 washer
16 fittings 38 round seal
18 sealant pistol 41 hex. screw NOTE:
19 sealant 42 hex. nut
20 plate screw 43 spring washer  means detailed figures

Fig. 2-7 Assembly of counterpoise (∅ 5 m) (1 of 2)

2-6 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
1 Assembly of center part  33,34 11
A
Unscrew antenna opening cover (11), re-use (33) and (34) to seĆ
cure (14) (see  A).

ø 480
MountL ring (14) with (33) and (34), then seal the joint betweenshelĆ
ter roof and L-ring completely using the sealant provided (18,19) 14
33,34
(see  B).
19 (18)
complete seal
Securethe 4 contact plates (10) to the two longer sides of the center B
part using plate screws (20). Cut off excess material (see ).

ø 480
Secure connection fittings (15) and (16) to upper ISO corners of ø 488
shelter with (9, 25, 26) (see ). center part

Lift center part onto shelter roof (use ring screws (44) as eye bolts) 38
and center. C
Screw connection fittings (15) and (16) to center part using (41, 42,
43) and (27, 28, 29) (see ).
ø 480

Remove the four ring screws (44).  10 20

center part
Insert round seal (38) between L ring of shelter roof and plate ring
of center part (access from inside shelter) (see  C).

cut off excess parts


2 Assembly of outer parts
 16 mirror symetrical
41
Secure four angle connectors (6) to lower shelter frame using (27, connection fitting
15 42
28) (see ). 43
27
28
Hang outer part onto pivots of center part, lift supports and screw 25 29
to outer part using connections (22, 23, 27). 26
front door
9

Screw outer parts and center part together using (27, 28; 14 reĆ  5 27, 28
quired per side) (see ).

3 Assembly of the CVOR antenna

After positioning and securing the CVOR antenna with the counterĆ
poise, seal the base ring and the antenna flange completely with
6
sealant (19). Use sealant pistol.
 27, 28

outer part

center part

Fig. 2-4 Assembly of counterpoise (∅ 5 m) (2 of 2)

Ed. 01.02 2-7


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2.2.3.2 Installation of the CVOR Antenna


See Figs. 2-8 to 2-13.

NOTE: The antenna should not normally be unpacked from its transportation crate until it is in
the immediate vicinity of the shelter.

WARNING

When installing the antenna on the shelter roof, observe any relevant safety regulations.

At least 3 to 4 people are required for handling the antenna, which weights approximately
115 kg. Handle the antenna carefully during transportation and installation. Take particuĆ
lar care with the antenna connection.
a) Installing the antenna with the aid of a crane:
- If a crane is used to install the antenna, hooks or similar should only be secured to the jack rings
on the cover plate (Fig. 2-8/4).
- Unpack the antenna (Fig. 2-8/2) and keep the joint sealing compound (washing bottle)
(Fig. 2-8/3) in a safe place.
- Raise the antenna onto the shelter roof with the aid of the crane, and position with the antenna
connection in the recess provided in the antenna adapter plate.
b) Installing the antenna without aid of a crane:
- Construct a sloping plane with two sufficiently stable beams and secure to the roof structure.
- Position the beams sufficiently far apart for the ends of the antenna to be laid on them.
- Roll the antenna up the beams, then install and position with the antenna connection in the recess
in the antenna adapter plate.

WARNING

Secure the antenna with anchoring wires or supports to prevent it falling over until it has
been screwed tight.

c) Further steps

- Mark the position of the two overlapping quarter-shells of the antenna cover (radome) and reĆ
move the shells.

CAUTION

There is a risk of damage to the antenna system when the quarter-shells are removed!

- Remove the transportation safeguard (2 angle bars) (Fig. 2-11/3).


- Position the ø 13 mm holes in the antenna base ring (Fig. 2-11/5) so that they are exactly congruĆ
ent with those in the antenna adapter plate (with the center section of the cover above it).

2-8 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
- Screw the antenna adapter plate (Fig. 2-9/1) to the antenna base ring (Fig. 2-9/3) to standard
tightness using 8 hexagonal bolts (Fig. 2-9/2).
- Remove the anchoring wires or supports.
- Screw the lower mount for the quarter-shells (Fig. 2-11/7) to the antenna adapter plate
(Fig. 2-11/8) to standard tightness using 8 hexagonal bolts.
- Loosen the 8 hexagonal bolts (Fig. 2-9/5) until the antenna base can be turned on the antenna
base ring.
- Insert a metal rod (Fig. 2-10/3) (or a long, sturdy screwdriver) into the two holes at the bottom of
the inner tube (Fig. 2-10/2).
- Turn the inner tube (and thus also the antenna system) as shown in Fig. 2-12 until the imaginary
line from the monitor mast to the longitudinal axis of the inner tube divides the 90° angle between
the two dipole halves into two sectors of 45°.
- Tighten the 8 hexagonal nuts (Fig. 2-9/5) to standard tightness.
- Remove the metal rod (or similar).
- Seal the joint (Fig. 2-11/4) with the joint sealing compound (Fig. 2-8/3).
- Secure the matching device subassembly in the immediate vicinity of the opening in the center of
the ceiling using self-tapping screws.
- Connect the coaxial cables (see Fig. 2-13).

1 2

1 Transportation crate
2 VOR antenna
3 Joint sealing compound
4 Cover plate with 2 jack rings

Fig. 2-8 CVOR antenna in transportation crate

Ed. 01.02 2-9


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

1 Antenna adapter plate


2 Hexagonal bolt
3 Antenna base ring
4 Washer
5 Hexagonal nut
6 Antenna base
(welded to inner tube)
7 Inner tube
8 Hexagonal bolt
9 Ring

Fig. 2-9 Locking device at antenna base

1 Radome (quarter shells)


2 Inner tube
3 Metal rod
4 Antenna base
5 Lower mount for quarter shells

Fig. 2-10 Mechanical alignment of antenna

2-10 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation

3
1 Underlapping quarter shells
2 Inner tube
3 Transportation safeguard
4 Joint 4
5 Antenna base ring
6 Antenna base
7 Lower mount for quarter shells
8 Antenna adapter plate 8 7 6 5

Fig. 2-11 Securing the CVOR antenna

monitor mast

45° 45°
CVOR antenna rotating

CVOR-antenna
Dipole A
Dipole B

Fig. 2-12 Mechanical alignment of the CVOR antenna

Ed. 01.02 2-11


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

VOR Antenna
83131 72401

Z1 A LR UR B

24029 28378

24029 28378
from transmitter cabinet

24029 28537
IN SB1
(W1) Z2
(W5)

Matching Device
IN CARR. CSB
(W3) 24029 28537 58317 24013
(W6)

24029 28537
IN SB2
(W2)

NOTE: The antenna should be connected to the matching device and the transmitter as shown in the diagram. The
matching device plate is located underneath the shelter roof next to the circular opening for the CVOR anĆ
tenna.

Fig. 2-13 Connecting diagram for CVOR antenna

2.2.3.3 Assembly of an Obstruction Light

If the antenna has to be fitted with obstruction lighting, the procedure is as follows:
- Remove the cover plate and keep in a safe place.
- Position the adapter for the obstruction light (Fig. 2-14) and screw to standard tightness.
- Lay the supply cable in the inner tube.
- Connect the lamp socket.
- Screw the lamp housing to the PG16 thread (PG16 = 16 mm armored thread).
- Connect the supply cable in the shelter.

PG16

Fig. 2-14 Adapter for obstruction light (Ref. no. 38150 28182)

2-12 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.2.3.4 Antenna Combinations
See Fig. 2-15.

The antenna can be combined with other antennas by mounting various adapters on the antenna
dome. In addition to the standard cover (antenna cover), Ref. no. 32436 28075, the following adapters
are available:

- Adapter for DME antenna ANS 96/86 + 87) Ref. no.. 32436 28078
- Adapter for TACAN antenna cable Ref. no. 32436 28077

Refer also to Section 2.7 Installation of DME antenna.

Adapter for DME antenna (ANS 96/86+87) Adapter for TACAN antenna cable
Ref. no. 32436 28078 Ref. no. 32436 28077

Fig. 2-15 Adapter for CVOR antenna

Ed. 01.02 2-13


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2.2.4 Installation of the Field Monitor and Monitor Mast


See Fig. 2-16.
Install the CVOR field monitor at a distance of 7...8 m from the center at the north side, e.g. between
the dipole A (SBA) and dipole B (SBB). The necessary mast (length approx. 7000 mm, ø130...180 mm,
material: wood) is normally supplied by the customer. It can also be supplied by ANS (Ref. No. 83130
03442). Two monitors at an angle of 90° may be used optionally.

wooden mast

field monitor

NORTH VOR monitor mast (monitor 1)

approx. 4500

protective pipe
7000...8000

approx. 1000

ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
VOR antenna
ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
cable duct
500...1000
(dipole A, B) min. 1600

max. 2500
VOR monitor mast (monitor 2)
optional

ARRANGEMENT

grounding conductor

INSTALLATION

(dimensions in [mm])

Fig. 2-16 Arrangement and installation CVOR field monitor

2-14 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.2.5 Installation of the Monitor Dipoles for 8 Point Ground Check Option
See Fig. 2-17.

Installation of the monitor dipoles for CVOR 8 point ground check option a mounting kit is available
(Ref.No. 83135 12050. To install the monitor dipoles for the 8 point ground check option proceed as
follows:

- The CVOR antenna system is completely installed.


- The monitor dipoles for 8 point ground check are mounted to the counterpoise edge or, for existing
CVOR counterpoise installations with no mounting facilities, on masts next to the counterpoise
edge. The installation position of the monitor dipoles above the counterpoise is recommended to
be about 800 mm (standard height). The dipoles are normally installed at the counterpoise edge.
For example, the dipoles can be fixed each on a GFK mast tube, which is mounted with clamps
at the edge of the counterpoise or on to wooden masts next to the counterpoise edge like the
mounting of the standard monitor dipole (Fig. 2-17).

NOTE: For correct measurement it is essential that the dipole are arranged correctly one to
another in a angle distance of 45° related to the centre of the counterpoise. This should
be regarded when aligning the CVOR antenna to North or the position of the first standard
dipole.

- The additional monitor cables are fed in a appropriate manner to the shelter.

The installation at the CVOR cabinet side is described in section 2.4.

CVOR antenna
8 PGC Dipole
approx.
Counterpoise 800 mm

Fig. 2-17 Height position of 8 PGC monitor dipoles

Ed. 01.02 2-15


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2-16 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.3 INSTALLATION AT THE RACK IN THE SHELTER
2.3.1 General
This chapter describes the connections at the transmitter rack: power supply, RF connections, interĆ
face connections and connection of a Remote Control (RMMC).
NOTE: For the Thales ATM shelter delivered with the navaids system all fuses are preinstalled.
If the shelter is provided by the customer, he will be responsible for the installation includĆ
ing a mains fuse box with arrester and a battery fuse box. Following fuse protection is
recommended: external mains fuse for transmitter cabinet F= C20A, for battery fuse
F1= K50A (power) and F2= G0.2A (sensor lines), regard also Fig. 2-6.
For a mains voltage of 115 VAC the standard mains wiring concept allows up to 3 ACC
modules. For a 115 VAC supply with 4 modules provided, standard mains wiring has to
be adapted concerning diameter of supply cables, size of mains terminals and mains filter.
2.3.2 Power Supply
2.3.2.1 Power Connections
See Fig. 2-18 to 2-19 and 2-25.
The terminal blocks for electrical and signal connections as listed below are installed on the BCPS
connection plate and the C-bar, which are located at the lower back side of the transmitter cabinet,
or on the cabinet bottom plate:
BCPS connection plate:
- 6 mains terminals L1, L2, L3, N, PE (Protective Earth) and FPE (Functional Protective Earth)
- 1 Speedy connector 26-pin for control signals to/from the BCPS from TX
- 2 single terminal blocks for battery (+ and -), factory wired
- 2 single terminal blocks for NAV equipment, factory wired
- 5 terminals for measuring lines to the battery, factory wired
C-bar:
- 2 single terminal blocks for connecting the battery (+B,-B)
- 5 terminals (2,1, F, F, 0) for measuring lines to the battery BAT2, BAT1, 2 BFUSE and BAT0
- 4 terminals (+D,-D; +R,-R) for connecting collocated DME and Radio Link (RL) equipment
- 1 single terminal block (+N,-N) for connecting the NAV equipment, factory wired
Bottom plate:
- 5 mains terminals L1, L2, L3, N, PE
- mains filter with mains terminals 4 In/4 Out/1 PE (european version only)
NOTE: The BCPS is a unit designed for "stationary operation", and its main connection and
protection measures should conform to VDE 0875, Table 2, Paras. 6 and 7. The unit fulfils
the protection class I of EN 60950. The following should be noted in particular:
S A permanently wired mains connection is recommended. The 230 VAC supply system
must be able to supply approx. 110 V in minimum, with an internal resistance of the
supply system < 0.5 ohms.
S If the wiring is not permanent, the plug-in connection must be protected against incorĆ
rect connection (e.g. Perilex or CEE connectors).
S The ground cable must be laid separately, and connected permanently to the FPE terĆ
minal and to the connecting bolt (BSE) of the rack.
S A ground fault interrupter must be provided for a rated fault current of 30 mA.

Ed. 01.02 2-17


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance
The connection must be done in the following sequence:

WARNING

Before connecting the cables check that the mains lead is dead and that the battery is
not connected.

- Set the ON/OFF switches of the ACC 54 units to OFF. Remove the units.
- Remove the rear panel.
- Connect a cable between the terminal FPE and the potential equalization bus.
- Connect the mains leads (nom. 115 to 230 VAC/50 Hz, single phase) to the terminals designated
L3, N and PE located on the bottom plate and from there to the corresponding terminals on the
BCPS connection plate. If a mains filter is installed on the bottom plate (European version only)
connect the mains leads to the corresponding terminals on the mains filter and from there to the
terminals on the BCPS connection plate. The protective earth should be connected to PE.
- Connect the cables to the battery terminals BAT+ and BAT- located on the C-bar taking care
not to connect them the wrong way round.
- Connect the measurement lines to the battery terminals BAT0, BAT1, BAT2 and BFUSE (2x) loĆ
cated on the C-bar if an auxiliary contact is available on the battery main switch.
- Connect the ground bolt (BSE) of the rack (Fig. 2-22) to the ground points and/or the potential
equalization bus of the shelter.

2.3.2.2 Connection of Battery Set

CAUTION

When connecting the DC supply observe the correct polarity (+ and -).

The battery set is connected via two pvc-insulated copper cables as per DIN 57281 with a cross-
sectional area of 16 mm2. The length of this connection is restricted to a maximum of 10 m for electrical
reasons.

Connect the leads to the terminals BAT (+) and BAT (-) on the C-bar. In order to protect the battery,
the positive line must have a 50 A fuse, if the battery monitoring program is used, and an automatic
overcurrent device (50 ADC) with signalling contact. Connect the signalling contacts to the terminals
BFUSE of the measuring line connector. Install the following cables for measuring purposes:

- from battery plus-pole via terminals of fuse switch F2 (in fuse box) to terminal BAT2 of
measuring line connector

- from the middle of the battery set via terminals of fuse switch F2 (in fuse box) to terminal BAT1
of the measuring line connector

- from battery minus-pole via terminals of fuse switch F2 (in fuse box) to terminal BAT0 of the
measuring line connector

2-18 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation

measuring line DME RL transmitter rack


battery terminal connector terminal terminal terminal C-bar mains terminal

to PMM Signboard

BAT BAT
Speedy

+B-B 2 1 F F0
+D -D +R -R +N -N
L1 L2 L3 N PE FPE
+
BAT BAT

NAV NAV
+
-

-
rear side of
transmitter rack

PE L3 L2
L2 L3
transmitter rack
N

PE
bottom plate with N L1
L2 L3

cable glands L1 N
L1

mains filter
(european version only)
5 mains terminal connectors position:
L3 N L1 L2
fuse box PE
F1 2 4 23
BFUSE L2 L1 N L3

50 A DC IN OUT

ÂÂÂ
BFUSE
1 3 24

ÂÂÂ
0.2 A F2
BAT2 mains connection box
BAT1 shelter
BAT0
230 VAC

48 V

+ -

emergency battery battery box

Signboard
-Battery
+Battery

BFUSE
BFUSE
UBAT2
UBAT1

UBAT0

+DME
-DME

+NAV
-NAV
+RL
-RL
+D
-D

+N
-N
+R
-R
+B

2
1
F
F
0
-B

factory wired

Fig. 2-18 Connections at the BCPS connection plate, C-bar and bottom plate

Ed. 01.02 2-19


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance
FPE
BP-BCPS shelter ground BP-C
PE
PE PE

Mains
N N
L3 L3
mains
L2 filter L2
L1 L1

bottom plate
Speedy 26pin, male X74

12 12 BCPS-OFF BCPS ON/OFF


1 1 "L" = ON
GND (HC-level
3 3 BBCPS1
Modules

7 7 BBCPS2 Status-report
11 11 Modul defective
BBCPS3 = "L"-(HC-level)
15 15 BBCPS4
5,19 5,19
5,19 GND
Flat ribbon cable
14
W109 14 NAV-
16 16 NAV+
18 18 IBAT-
20 Current measurement
20 IBAT+
9 9 UBAT-
22 22 UBAT1+
13 13 Voltage measurement
UBAT-
24 24 UBAT2+
19 19 OPTO_GND
Opto in
17 17 BFUSE (in_opto+24) BFUSE

RL + S3 PMM
RL -
DME + S1
DME -
S2
+54 V +NAV
2mOhm F2 F1

Iload 0V -NAV
C bar

K1

X1

+BAT F1
+BAT X83
(to CSL)
50 A DC
BFUSE

BFUSE BP-DC
GND TX1 MON
LRCI
TX2 BP-T
0.2 A F2 CSL BP-C
BAT2
+

BAT1 48 V

BAT0
-

Ibat -BAT

2mOhm Fuse box


Shelter
Battery room Cabinet

Fig. 2-19 Power supply cabling: BCPS connection plate, C-bar and bottom plate, PMM

2-20 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.3.3 RF-Connections at Transmitter Rack
See Fig. 2-20, 2-25.
Make the following cable connections:

Transmitter Rack Cable No. Antenna Base Matching Device


SB1 W1 A
SB2 W2 B
CSB W3 IN CSB

Make the following cable connections, if one field monitor dipole is used:

Transmitter Rack Cable No. CP1 (T-piece) Cable No. Monitor Dipole
MON1 CP1 out
MON2 W7 CP1 out
CP1 IN W4 Monitor Dipole

Make the following cable connections, if two field monitor dipoles are used:

Transmitter Rack Cable No. CP1 (T-piece) Cable No. Monitor Dipole
MON1 W4 - - Monitor Dipole 1
MON2 W5 - - Monitor Dipole 2

The cable to the monitor(s) is fed from the monitor mast through a cable entry (bottom of the shelter).

Connections for 8 point ground check refer to section 2.4.

Transmitter rack
top view

SB1
LGM1 Local PC ASU DIAGNOSIS DME-IDENT

CSB LGM2/DME LGM3/NDB VAM ANALOG OIO LCP IN OIO LCP OUT

SB2

MON2 MON1
BCPS

Field dipole 2 Field dipole 1

rear side

Fig. 2-20 CVOR Transmitter rack, top view, connectors

Ed. 01.02 2-21


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2.3.4 External Interface Connections and Pin Assignments

See Fig. 2-20, 2-22.

The following connectors are available on the top and front of the cabinet:

- DME-IDENT analog DME interface


- DIAGNOSIS communication interface diagnostics
- LGM1 dedicated line connection (to RMMC) with use of LGM 1200MD or
PTT connection (optional) or serial communication interface
- LGM2/DME PTT connection (LGM 28.8) or serial communication interface DME
- LGM3/NDB PTT connection (LGM 28.8) or serial communication interface NDB
- ANALOG measurement purposes
- Local PC local operation with ADRACS
- VAM optional voice or ATIS connection, e.g. from tower
- OIO LCP IN spare in, optocoupler
- OIO LCP OUT spare out, optocoupler

2.3.4.1 DME-IDENT

SubD, 37pin, male, from connector X85 BP-C. Refer to section 2.6.

2.3.4.2 DIAGNOSIS

SubD, 9pin, male, from connector X86 BP-C


PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 DCD 6 DSR
2 RXD 7 RTS
3 TXD 8 CTS
4 DTR 9 RI
5 GND

2.3.4.3 LGM1

SubD, 9pin, male, from connector X92 or X97 BP-C; X92 = LGM modem output
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 La 6 E
2 Lb 7 not used
3 A2 8 not used
4 B2 9 not used
5 GND
X97 = TTL (direct)
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 DCD 6 DSR
2 RXD 7 RTS
3 TXD 8 CTS
4 DTR 9 RI
5 GND

2-22 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.3.4.4 LGM2/DME
SubD, 9pin, male, from connector X93 or X98 BP-C; X93 = LGM modem output
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 La 6 DSR
2 Lb 7 RTS
3 A2 8 CTS
4 B2 9 RI
5 GND
X98 = TTL/RS232 (direct)
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 DCD 6 DSR
2 RXD 7 RTS
3 TXD 8 CTS
4 DTR 9 RI
5 GND
X98 = RS422 (direct)
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 TXD+ 6 RXD+
2 TXD- 7 RXD-
3 not used 8 not used
4 not used 9 not used
5 not used
2.3.4.5 LGM3/NDB
SubD, 9pin, female, from connector X94 or X99 BP-C; X94 = LGM modem output
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 La 6 DSR
2 Lb 7 RTS
3 A2 8 CTS
4 B2 9 RI
5 GND
X99 = TTL/RS232 (direct)
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 DCD 6 DSR
2 RXD 7 RTS
3 TXD 8 CTS
4 DTR 9 RI
5 GND
X99 = RS422 (direct)
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 TXD+ 6 RXD+
2 TXD- 7 RXD-
3 not used 8 not used
4 not used 9 not used
5 not used

Ed. 01.02 2-23


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2.3.4.6 ANALOG
SubD, 9pin, female, from connector X84 BP-C
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 ANALOG-IN1 6 ANALOG-IN2
2 ANALOG-IN3 7 ANALOG-IN4
3 ANALOG-IN5 8 ANALOG-IN6
4 15 VN-A (-15 V) 9 15 VP-A (+15 V)
5 AGND

2.3.4.7 Local PC
SubD, 9pin, male, from connector X4 of LCP
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 DCD 6 DSR
2 RXD 7 RTS
3 TXD 8 CTS
4 DTR 9 RI
5 GND

2.3.4.8 VAM

SubD, 9pin, female, from connector X95 BP-C

PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT


1 LV1 6 LVG
2 LV2 7
3 SYNCH 8
4 SYNCR 9
5 GND

2.3.4.9 OIO LCP IN


SubD, 25pin, male, to connector X2 of LCP via X82 BP-C
PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT
1 GND 14 VCC (+5 V)
2 TTLOUT3 (internal use) 15 IAUX0
3 IAUX1 16 IAUX2
4 IAUX3 17 IAUX4
5 IAUX5 18 IAUX6
6 IAUX7 19 IAUX8
7 IAUX9 20 IAUX10
8 IAUX11 21 IAUX12
9 IAUX13 22 IAUX14
10 IAUX15 23 TTLIN0 (internal use)
11 TTLIN1 (internal use) 24 TTLIN2 (internal use)
12 TTLOUT4 (internal use) 25 TTLIN3 (internal use)
13 GND

2-24 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.3.4.10 OIO LCP OUT

SubD, 25pin, female, from connector X2 of LCP via X82 BP-C

PIN ASSIGNMENT PIN ASSIGNMENT


1 COM3 (common connect 3) 14 COM4 (common connect 4)
2 TTLOUT2 (internal use) 15 OAUX0
3 OAUX1 16 OAUX2
4 OAUX3 17 OAUX4
5 OAUX5 18 OAUX6
6 OAUX7 19 COM1 (common connect 1)
7 OAUX8 20 OAUX9
8 OAUX10 21 OAUX11
9 OAUX12 22 OAUX13
10 OAUX14 23 OAUX15
11 COM2 (common connect 2) 24 TTLOUT0 (internal use)
12 TTLOUT1 (internal use) 25 VCC (+5 V)
13 GND

Ed. 01.02 2-25


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2.3.5 External Interfaces, Cable Connections


2.3.5.1 Connection of Remote Control RMMC
- Dedicated line modem LGM1200MD: Connect a two wire line from RMMC to pins 1 and 2 of a
SubD, 9pin connector and connect to connector LGM1 on top of the cabinet.
NOTE: For LGM1200MD the ends of the dedicated line (station and remote side) have to be
terminated (600 ohms/47 nF parallel). The RC combination may be soldered to the
9pin SubD connector together with the two wire line.
- Switched line modem: Connect a two wire line from PTT/RMMC to pins 1 and 2 of a SubD, 9pin
connector and connect to connector LGM1 (or LGM2, LGM3, if modem assembled) on top of the
cabinet.
2.3.5.2 Connection of a local PC or Laptop
Connect V.24 cable (0Ćmodem cable) with SubD, 9pin from PC to connect. Local PC on top of cabinet.
2.3.5.3 Connection of Voice Signal for VAM
Connect a two wire line from RMMC to pins 1 and 2 of a SubD, 9pin connector and connect to connecĆ
tor VAM on top of the cabinet.
2.3.5.4 Connection of auxiliary Inputs/Outputs (LCP)
The Navaids installation contains an auxiliary interface (on LCP board) with 16 optocoupler inputs and
16 optocoupler outputs for additional signals which is at the user's disposal. The external wiring of
the OIO connectors is shown in Fig. 2-21.
2.3.5.5 Connection of auxiliary Analog and Temp inputs (CSL)
Connect voltage measurement lines to plug SubD, 9pin and connect to connector ANALOG on top
of the cabinet. Connect sensor PT1000 for temperature measurement via cable and tabs to X81/1,2
or 3,4, rear BP-C. The wiring is shown in Fig. 2-22.
OIO-IN conn.
outside IAUX n VCC (+5 V)

2k2
IAUX 0...7 and IAUX 8...15 when active low load max.
<2V or <2k7
log. 0= max. 0.3 mA
log. 1= min. 0.7 mA

GND
outside
VCC (+5 V) / max. 24 V

IAUX 8...15 when active high


(selectablewith jumpers J1...4, refer to 6.2.4.1) IAUX n
GND
2k2
log. 0= max. 0.3 mA
log. 1= min. 0.7 mA/max. 10 mA
OIO-OUT conn.
outside OAUX n
OAUX 0...3/4...7/8...11/12...15 +
60 VDC
100 mA max.

NOTE: - GND
dc COM1 used for OAUX0...3
Only voltages in the SELV range (up to 60 VDC) must be COM3 used for OAUX4...7
COM4 used for OAUX8...11
connected to connectors OAUX . COM2 used for OAUX12...15
(SELV=Safety Extra Low Voltage)

Fig. 2-21 External wiring of auxiliary OIO connectors of LCP

2-26 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
Local PC operation, via connector Local PC
on top of the cabinet

ÊÊ Ê
ÊÊ Ê
ÊÊ Ê
X87 X86 X79 X78
Analog signals to CSL (ext.) via

ÊÊ Ê
X85 X82 connector ANALOG, top of
X94 X93 X92 X80
the cabinet

ÊÊ Ê
control line BCPS
X99 X98 X97 X96 X77 X76 X84

ÊÊ Ê
Voice input via connector VAM X73
on top of the cabinet BP-C X74

ÊÊ Ê
X83
X95 -3 - 1

ÊÊ Ê
X72 X71 -4 - 2

ÊÊ Ê
Assignment of aux. measurement
inputs: X81 für Temp.-Sensor PT1000

ÊÊ Ê
ANALOG, SubD, 9pin
PIN ASSIGNMENT

ÊÊ Ê
50W TX2
1 Analog IN 1 X70 TX1
BP-T

ÊÊ Ê
X71 X84 100W
2 Analog IN 2 X81
X84 X81
3 Analog IN 3 (TX1)
X83

ÊÊ Ê
X72
4 Analog IN 4 X85 X82 50W TX2
5 Analog IN 5

ÊÊ Ê
100W TX1
6 Analog IN 6 X83 X82

ÊÊ Ê
9 AGND
CA-100/1* TX2

ÊÊ Ê
X84 X80
TX1
X85

ÊÊ Ê
39k2 X80 Setting example: 100 W, TX1
A-IN X70
BP-T

ÊÊ Ê
X71 X84 1
±20 V 10k
X81 TX2
X83 2

ÊÊ Ê
X72 TX1
AGND (TX2) X85 X82
3

ÊÊ Ê
ÊÊ
ÊÊ
X80
Ê
Ê
X81 BP-C, flat plug
PIN ASSIGNATION ÊÊ
ÊÊ
PMM Ê
Ê
TX2
X80

1
2

ÊÊ Ê
TX1
/1 TEMP1 3

/2 TEMP1 BP-DC
/3 TEMP2
/4 TEMP2
ÊÊ
ÊÊ
CA-100/2* Ê
Ê
ÊÊ Ê
X81
5V

PT1000
1,3
3k9

TEMP ÊÊ
ÊÊ Ê
Ê
ÊÊ Ê
47k4
2,4

ÊÊ Ê
AGND

ÊÊ Ê
Battery and power supply connection

control line BCPS


ÊÊ
ÊÊ Ê
Ê
ÊÊ Ê
BP-BCPS

ground bolt (BSE)


Ê
* 100 W only

Fig. 2-22 Transmitter cabinet, rear side, interface connections

Ed. 01.02 2-27


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2-28 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.4 INSTALLATION OF 8 PGC OPTION AT THE CVOR RACK
2.4.1 General
- The CVOR antenna system is completely installed. The 8 PGC monitor dipoles are installed acĆ
cording section 2.2.5.
To install the 8 point ground check (8 PGC) option to one equipment the following parts are required:
- 2 MSP-V8 83134 22600 (incl. adapted SW-EPROM)
- 1 MDS-V8 83135 20700 (incl. adapted SW-EPROM)
- Semi-rigid cables, pre-formed:
W12 24026 29071 (used for connection MDS to MSP/2)
W16 24026 29075 (used for connection MDS to MSP/1)
W70 to W77 24026 29276 to ..... 29283 (used for connection MON1...8 to MDS)
- Disassembling tool 24339 28050 (used for RF cable connectors)
- Site files and LKE files (used for station definition)
- ADRACS SW adapted to CVOR 8 PGC option (used for operation and monitoring)

2.4.2 Installation Procedure


See Fig. 2-23, 2-24.
To change over the standard CVOR 431 to the CVOR 431 with optional 8 point ground check monitor
perform the following steps:

CAUTION

Before performing any changes or replacements to the CVOR equipment, switch power
off.

- Switch main power off for the CVOR installation.


- Remove both modules MSP-VD, Ref. No. 83134 22301
- Remove semi-rigid monitor cables W56 and W57 (TNC connector female). Use disassembling
tool 24339 28050 to remove coaxial connectors from the backpanel (Fig. 2-24).
- Loosen all RF and AF connections from the connector plate on top of the cabinet.
- Push out the pre-punched holes for the additional TNC-connectors used for 8 PGC.
- Connect all loosened RF and AF cables to the prepared connector plate as before.
- Assemble cables W70 to W77 to the backpanel BP-C and to the connectors MON1 to MON8 on
top of the cabinet (see Fig. 2-24).
- Assemble cables W12 and W16 into the backpanel BP-C (see Fig. 2-24, connection MDS to
MSP's).
- Adjust coaxial connectors central to the hole in the insulating part of the connector.
- Put new modules MSP-V8, part-No. 83134 22600 in the MSP-VD position.
- Put module MDS-V8, part-No. 83135 20700 in the MDS position.

Ed. 01.02 2-29


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance
- Connect monitor dipole antennas to the inputs MON1 to MON8. Maximum input level is ć8 dBm,
minimum input level is ć35 dBm.

NOTE: The Monitor takes the signals of 8 monitor dipoles at the edge of the counterpoise. The
dipole MON1 may be replaced by the conventional monitor field dipole.

All dipoles have to be within a 45° raster. Deviations up to ±5° may be adjusted by the
calibrate function of the software.

- Finally check correct cabling and tight fitting of RF cables.

2-30 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.4.2.1 Connections at Transmitter Rack
See Fig. 2-23.
The cable to the monitor dipoles is fed from the monitor masts or fastenings through a cable entry
of the shelter (bottom of the shelter).

Make the following new cable connections within the transmitter rack, rear side (Fig. 2-24):

Connector cover plate, Backpanel BP-CD


Connector Cable No. Module (Monitor Dipole)
MON1 W70 MDS 8 PGC Monitor Dipole 1 or standard monitor
MON2 W71 MDS 8 PGC Monitor Dipole 2
MON3 W72 MDS 8 PGC Monitor Dipole 3
MON4 W73 MDS 8 PGC Monitor Dipole 4
MON5 W74 MDS 8 PGC Monitor Dipole 5
MON6 W75 MDS 8 PGC Monitor Dipole 6
MON7 W76 MDS 8 PGC Monitor Dipole 7
MON8 W77 MDS 8 PGC Monitor Dipole 8

Backpanel BP-CD
Connector Cable No. Module (Signal)
MDS-V W12 MSP-V/1 RFMON1
MDS-V W16 MSP-V/2 RFMON2

Transmitter rack
top view

(D)VOR (D)VOR
SB1
LGM1 Local PC ASU DIAGNOSIS DME-IDENT

CSB

ÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂ
LGM2/DME LGM3/NDB VAM ANALOG OIO LCP IN OIO LCP OUT

ÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂ
DVOR
CVOR MON4 MON3 MON2 MON1
DVOR
CVOR
SB2

BCPS MON1 MON2 MON3 MON4 MON5 MON6 MON7 MON8

rear side

8 point ground check monitor dipoles (MON1 ...8)

Fig. 2-23 CVOR transmitter rack, top view, replaced cover with additional connectors

Ed. 01.02 2-31


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

CVOR standard connections


RFMON2 RFMON1
Remove:

Ê Ê
Ê Ê
W56 : 24026 29125 W57 W56
W57 : 24026 29116

Ê Ê
Ê Ê
X87 X86 X79 X78

Ê X94 X93 X92 X85 X82


Ê
Ê Ê
X80

Ê Ê
Ê Ê
X99 X98 X97 X96 X77 X76
X84

Ê Ê
X73
BP-C

Ê Ê
MDS MSP2 MSP1
X74

Ê Ê
X83

Ê Ê
X95 - 3 - 1

X72 X71 - 4 - 2

Ê Ê
Ê Ê
Ê rear view
Ê
Ê Ê
CVOR 8 PGC connections
Replace: MON1 MON2 MON3 MON4 MON5 MON6 MON7 MON8
cover plate by new cover plate
remount connectors

Ê Ê
mount additional monitor input connectors 0° 45° 90° 135° 180° 225° 270° 315°

Ê Ê
W70 W71 W72 W73 W74 W75 W76 W77
Connect:

Ê Ê
W12 : 24026 29071
W16 : 24026 29075 X87 X86 X79 X78

W70 : 2402629276
W71 : 24026 29277
Ê X85
Ê
Ê Ê
X94 X93 X92 X82
W72 : 24026 29278 MDS
W73 : 24026 29279 X80

Ê Ê
W74 : 24026 29280
W75 : 24026 29281
W76 : 24026 29282

Ê Ê
W77 : 24026 29283
X99 X98 X97 X96 X77 X76
X84

Ê
Ê
BP-C
MDS MSP2 MSP1
X73

X74
Ê
Ê
Ê Ê
W12 W16
X83

Ê Ê
X95 - 3 - 1

X72 X71 - 4 - 2

Ê
Ê Ê
Ê
Ê
Ê
rear view Ê
Ê
Fig. 2-24 Transmitter cabinet, new cabling for 8 point ground check option

2-32 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation

Location at counterpoise edge CVOR ANTENNA


MONITOR DIPOLE 2 to 8 (8 PGC option) MONITOR DIPOLE 1 MONITOR DIPOLE 2

counterpoise
NOTE:
If two monitor dipoles are used,
cable W5 is fed to input MON 2.
W4 24029 28521 W5 to MON 2 A B LR UR MATCHING DEVICE Z2
IN
URS LRS CSB

W7
xxx041
MON 8

MON 7

MON 6

MON 5

MON 4

MON 3

MON 2

MON 1

SB1

SB2

CSB

W1 24029 28537 24029 28378 (part of matching device)


Optional Cabling
OUT W2 24029 28537 24029 28378 (part of matching device)
TRANSMITTER RACK
Cabling with 8 point ground check option W3 24029 28537
CP1
IN

OUT
MON 1

MON 2

SB1

SB2

CSB
NOTE:
PVC shielded power lines (W60 to W71, W10) are
included in the battery cable set 58341 00030.
W61 24039 28226 TX1/TX2
W63 24039 28228 GND
FUSE BOX
F1 2 4 23
BFUSE W69 24039 28234
50 A DC
BFUSE W71 24039 28235
W60 24039 28225 1 3 24

W64 24039 28229 BAT2 0.2 A F2 24039 28234


W70
1 2
W65 24039 28230 BAT1 W67 24039 28232
24039 28231 BAT0 3 4
W68 24039 28233 MAINS DISTRIBUTION Legend
W66 5 6 BOX
N
BFUSE
BFUSE

W62 W10 24039 28052


NAV-
NAV+

+ -
BAT-
BAT+
BAT0
BAT1
BAT2

24039 28227
TNC
PE

L3
N

48 V BATTERY BOX BSE SHELTER


BCPS CONNECTION PLATE

Fig. 2-25 System cabling CVOR

Ed. 01.02 2-33


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.5 GROUNDING
2.5.1 General
The type of grounding implemented is dependent on the local terrain. Consequently it is only possible
to provide general guidelines here. Grounding conductors or rods are metallic elements of a particular
form which are either driven into the ground or laid in the ground so as to cover a relatively large area.
All connections in the ground must be welded and protected against corrosion. The ground resisĆ
tance required for a CVOR (or other navigation installations) can be given as  5 W. This resistance
can only be measured precisely with the aid of special ground resistance measuring equipment. The
exact measuring procedure is described in the operating instructions for these devices. Universally
valid instructions are given in Section 2.5.6. Sufficient grounding can generally be obtained if the
installation suggestions described below and the terrain conditions are paid attention to. When estiĆ
mating the ground resistance the length and extent of the network laid are the crucial points, not the
cross-sectional area of the conductors. Favorable resistance conditions are provided by arable land
and loamy ground (ground resistivity 100 W per meter). The data specified below applies to these
conditions. With other types of terrain the factors below must be taken into consideration (increase
in the resistance with respect to the basic values stated).
Moist sandy soil 2x
Dry sandy soil 5 to 10x
Gravel or stones up to 30x
If the ground is not chemically neutral, e.g. if it is salty, it may be necessary to coat all metal parts laid
in the ground with lead or to use a sufficiently non-corrosive steel (e.g. V2A). The different types are
as follows:

ÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂ
ÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂÂ 0.5...1 m

Radial ground Ground rod or plate Interlinked ground

Fig. 2-26 Different types of ground conductor configuration

2.5.2 Strip or mesh Ground Conductors


Strip ground conductors take the form of a strip, round material or cable laid in the ground at a depth
of 0.5 to 1 m so as to cover a relatively large area.

Materials:
Steel strip (hot galvanized) 100 mm@, min. thickness 3 mm
Copper strip 50 mm@, min. thickness 2 mm
Copper cable (not finely-stranded) 135 mm@

Ed. 01.02 2-35


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance
The network should be laid as symmetrical to the CVOR station as possible. The necessary length
and extension when laid in a straight line, should be estimated from the basic data below.

Strip length Ground resistance

25 m 10 W
50 m 5W
100 m 3W

2.5.3 Ground Rods

Ground rods are either pipes or U, L or T-shaped profiles driven vertically into the ground and 1 to
2 m in length. It is necessary to connect several ground rods together in order to reduce the grounding
resistance. The minimum spacing is twice the length of each ground rod.

Material: Steel (hot galvanized) Pipe 30 x 3 mm


Bracket L 65 x 65 x 7 mm
U-profile U 65 DIN 1026
T-profile T 60 DIN 1024

Probable grounding resistance of a rod: Length 1 m approx. 70 W


Length 2 m approx. 40 W

The material, cross sectional areas and grounding resistance of the connecting leads to the shelter
should be as for strip ground conductors, (see Section 2.5.2). When pipe-type grounding rods are
fastened with clamps, screws at least M10 in size should be used.

2.5.4 Ground Plates

Ground plates are solid perforated sheet metal plates with dimensions of approx. 0.5 x 1 m or
1 x 1 m, which are embedded vertically in the ground. The top edge of the plates should always be
at least 1 m below the surface. Several ground plates must be connected in parallel in order to reduce
the grounding resistance. The minimum spacing should be 3 m. Material:

Sheet steel (hot galvanized) min. thickness 3 mm


Sheet copper min. thickness 2 mm

The ground resistance of a plate 1 m@ is approx. 30 W. The data for the connecting conductors is speĆ
cified in the tables in Section 2.5.2.

2.5.5 Estimating the Ground Resistance

The resistance of each rod, each plate and each supply line used should be determined on the basis
of Section 2.5.2 to 2.5.4. They should be considered as parallel resistances. The resulting grounding
resistance should then be calculated as follows: 1/Rres =1/R1+1/R2+1/R3+...+ Rn. Taking into acĆ
count the nature of the terrain (for factors see Section 2.5.1) satisfactory grounding conditions can
be assumed if the ground resistance calculated from the base data is < 5 W. If the value calculated
is 5 W or more, we recommend measuring the ground resistance.

2-36 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.5.6 Measuring the Ground Resistance
See Fig. 2-27.
Three measurements must be performed over a large area in order to determine the ground resisĆ
tance precisely. The distance between 2 auxiliary grounds required must be large in relation to the
complete ground network of the navigation installation. Two steel rods approx. 1 m long should be
used as auxiliary grounds (reinforcing bars); these should be driven into the ground with only a few
centimeters remaining at the designated points. It is essential that the rods are of equal length and
are driven in to the same depth.

approx. 10 m

VOR counterpoise

>50 m >50 m

>50 m
Auxiliary ground 2 Auxiliary ground 1

Fig. 2-27 Determining of the ground resistance

Example of a CVOR plate ground with 5 x 2 plates, each 1 m2. The drawing is not to scale. A theoretical
ground resistance of approx. 2 W (good) would be obtained on the basis of the 10 plates, connecting
conductors and assumed terrain conditions (e.g. arable land) in accordance with the formula in SecĆ
tion 2.5.5.

Measurements are performed as shown in the diagram below:

E = Installation ground E
H1 = Auxiliary ground 1
M1 M3
H2 = Auxiliary ground 2
M1 = Measured value 1
H1 H2
M2 = Measured value 2
M3 = Measured value 3 M2

Measured value 1: Resistance between installation ground and auxiliary ground 1


Measured value 2: Resistance between auxiliary ground 1 and auxiliary ground 2
Measured value 3: Resistance between installation ground and auxiliary ground 2

Ed. 01.02 2-37


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance
When the three measurements have been performed the ground resistance is calculated as follows:

Corr. meas. value 1 + corr. meas. 3 - corr. meas. value 2


Ground resistance =
2

The measurement is falsified by the resistance of the 2 test leads. The cross-sectional area of the
test leads should not be less than 1.5 mm@ in order to ensure an adequate breaking strength. With
this cross-sectional area and an assumed length of 2 x 25 m = 50 m, the falsifying resistance would
be 0.58 W. This resistance should therefore be measured and deducted from measured values 1, 2
and 3. The measured values corrected in this manner are entered into the above formula.

2-38 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.6 COLLOCATION WITH DME/TACAN
2.6.1 Overview
See Figs. 2-29, 2-42, 2-43, 2-47.
This description concerns to the collocation of DME FSD 40/45, DME 415/435 or TACAN FTA 43 with
a CVOR 431. The DME or TACAN equipment is normally located in the CVOR shelter. To synchronize
the identification, the collocated DME (TACAN) uses an interface with the CVOR system. To transfer
"Maintenance" and "Status" of the DME (TACAN) a RS 232-cable connection is established between
CVOR and DME (TACAN) if these are not connected with an individual modem (internal or external)
to the Tower resp. RCSE 443 via a 2 wire lines connection. These examples are shown in Fig. 2-42,
2-43 and 2-47. The terminal points in the AF-distribution box, which may be used for 2 wire connecĆ
tion, are shown in Fig. 2-29.
Further information to the DME FSD 40/45 will be found in the Technical Manual Ref.No. 8BR 02016
1000 DEGFA, to the DME 415/435 in the manual Ref.No. 8BR 0212 1000 DEGFA and to the TACAN
FTA 43 in the manual Ref.No. DE 0360071-18/1E or Ref.No. DE 0360071-18/2E.

2.6.2 Connection FSD 40/45 to CVOR 431


See Figs. 2-28, 2-30, 2-33.
The FSD 40/45 is installed in two versions: a CSB-version and an IOM-version. The CSB-version
itself is built in a version with the connector panel (I/O-panel) mounted at the rear side of the cabinet,
and another version with the connector panel mounted on top of the cabinet (Fig. 2-30, 2-33).
The CSB-versions are described in Section 2.6.2.1 and 2.6.2.2, the IOM-version in Section 2.6.2.3.
Fig. 2-28 shows the pin assignment of the DME-IDENT and LGM2 interface (VOR) used to connect
the DME. Regard the configuration of the subassembly CSL of the CVOR in Section 2.6.2.4. CorresĆ
ponding information to the DME (TACAN) will be found in the corresponding manual.

2.6.2.1 CSB-Version, I/O-panel at the rear of cabinet


See Figs. 2-30, 2-31, 2-32.
- Lay the ID-cable (Ref.No. 24009 28148) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the connector
VOR(SK26) on the rear side of the DME cabinet and to connector DME-IDENT on top of the CVOR
cabinet (Fig. 2-30 and 2-31).
- To establish the RS 232 connection plug adapter Ref.No. 97243 28211 (Fig. 2-30 and 2-32) to
connector PL1 at the DME I/O panel, rear side.
- Place the RS 232-cable (Ref.No. 97240 28166) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the adapter
(DME cabinet) and to connector LGM2 on top of the CVOR cabinet.

2.6.2.2 CSB-Version, I/O-panel on top of the cabinet


See Figs. 2-33, 2-34, 2-35.
- Lay the ID-cable (Ref.No. 24009 28148) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the connector
IFV/SK10 on top of the DME cabinet and to connector DME-IDENT on top of the CVOR cabinet
(Fig. 2-33 and 2-34).
- To establish the RS 232 connection plug adapter Ref.No. 97243 28211 (Fig. 2-33 and 2-35) to
connector PL1 at the DME I/O panel, on top of the cabinet.
- Place the RS 232-cable (Ref.No. 97240 28166) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the adapter
(DME cabinet) and to connector LGM2 on top of the CVOR cabinet.

Ed. 01.02 2-39


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2.6.2.3 IOM-Version
See Figs. 2-36, 2-37, 2-38.
- Lay the ID-cable (Ref.No. 24009 28148) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the connector
VOR(SK26) on the rear side of the DME cabinet and to connector DME-IDENT on top of the CVOR
cabinet (Fig. 2-36 and 2-37).
- To establish the RS 232 connection plug adapter Ref.No. 97243 28214 (Fig. 2-36 and 2-38) to
connector "AUX1" on the DME IOM, at the rear side of the cabinet, lower section.
- Place the RS 232-cable (Ref.No. 97240 28168) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the adapter
(DME cabinet) and to connector LGM2 on top of the CVOR cabinet.

2.6.2.4 Configuration of CVOR 431 and DME FSD 40/45 or TACAN FTA 43
- CVOR 431:
Set switch S5 (see Section 6.2.4) on front of the CSL (Ref.No. 83134 23101), which is set for stanĆ
dard use of the CVOR, to position "ASSOC." for the application with a collocated DME FSD 40/45.
- DME FSD 40/45:
Refer to Technical Manual, Ref.No. 8BR 020 161000 DEGFA.
- TACAN FTA 43:
Refer to Technical Manual, Ref.No. SNR DE 0360071-18/1E.

2.6.3 Connection TACAN FTA 43 to CVOR 431


See Figs. 2-39, 2-40, 2-41.
- Lay the ID-cable (Ref.No. 24009 28148) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the connector
VOR(SK3) on the rear side of the TACAN cabinet and to connector DME-IDENT on top of the
CVOR cabinet (Fig. 2-39 and 2-40).
- To establish the RS 232 connection plug adapter Ref.No. 97243 28214 (Fig. 2-39 and 2-41) to
connector "AUX1" on the TACAN IOM, at the rear side of the cabinet, upper section.
- Place the RS 232-cable (Ref.No. 97240 28168) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the adapter
(TACAN cabinet) and to connector LGM2 on top of the CVOR cabinet.

2-40 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
CVOR 431 cabinet

rear top

(RS 232-connection)
1
6
2 RX

LGM2
7
3 TX
8
W1xx 9
4
5 GND

X98 20
1
2
21
3
22
4
Subrack BP-C 23
5
24
6
25
7
26
8

DME IDENT
27
9
28
10
29
11
30
IDENT from CSL X2

12
31
13
32
14
33
15
24V ID 34
W100 DMSL 35
16 DME-ID
17 DMSR
VOR OP 36
18 DMOVS
GND DME 37
19 GND DME
X85

Fig. 2-28 Interface Assignment of LGM2 and DME-Ident in CVOR 431

AF distribution box

Terminal bar
Plug-in holder for overvoltage arrester removed

3a 3a
3b 3b

2a 2a
2b 2b

1a 1a
1b 1b

Fig. 2-29 AF-distribution box, assignment of terminals (example)

Ed. 01.02 2-41


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

Shelter
97240 28166
RS 232

24009 28148
ID
LGM2 DME-IDENT

I/O-Panel
Adapter
PL1

VOR (SK26)

CVOR DME
(FSD 40/45)

(CSB-Version)

Fig. 2-30 CSB-Version, I/O panel at cabinet rear side, connection CVOR to DME

CVOR 431 DME FSD 40/45


connector DME-IDENT connector VOR(SK26)
37pin, male 25pin, female
SIGNAL NAME PIN PIN SIGNAL NAME
DME-ID 16 16 4 4 MORCO
DMOVS 18 18 6 6 BCNFTY
GNDDME 19 19 24 24 SIGNAL GND
37 37 3 3 SIGNAL GND
U15+ 33 5 5 SIGNAL GND
VOR OP 36 36 25 25 AFFTY
24V ID 34 34 12 12 +24V
DMSL 35 35
DMSR 17 17
1 kOhm
24009 28148 (ID cable)

Fig. 2-31 CSB-Version, I/O panel at cabinet rear side, ident connection CVOR to DME

CVOR 431 DME FSD 40/45,


connector LGM2 connector PL1
9pin, male 25pin, male
97243 28211
(Adapter, male/female) PIN SIGNAL NAME
SIGNAL NAME PIN
RX 2 2 2 2 TD (BA)
TX 3 3 3 3 RD (BB)
GND 5 5 5 7 SC, CR, (AB) GND
RS232
RS232
97240 28166 (9pin, female/female, 3 m)

Fig. 2-32 CSB-Version, I/O panel at cabinet rear side, RS 232 connection CVOR/DME

2-42 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation

Shelter
97240 28166
RS 232
24009 28148
ID
IFV/SK10
DME-IDENT Adapter
LGM2
PL1

DME
CVOR (FSD 40/45)

(CSB-Version)

Fig. 2-33 CSB-Version, I/O panel on cabinet top, connection CVOR to DME

CVOR 431 DME FSD 40/45


connector DME-IDENT connector IFV/SK10
37pin, male 25pin, female
SIGNAL NAME PIN PIN SIGNAL NAME
DME-ID 16 16 4 4 MORCO
DMOVS 18 18 6 6 BCNFTY
GNDDME 19 19 24 24 SIGNAL GND
37 37 3 3 SIGNAL GND
U15+ 33 5 5 SIGNAL GND
VOR OP 36 36 25 25 AFFTY
24V ID 34 34 12 12 +24V
DMSL 35 35
DMSR 17 17
1 kOhm
24009 28148 (ID cable)

Fig. 2-34 CSB-Version, I/O panel on cabinet top, ident connection VOR/DME

CVOR 431 DME FSD 40/45


connector LGM2 connector PL1
9pin, male 25pin, male
97243 28211
(Adapter, male/female) PIN SIGNAL NAME
SIGNAL NAME PIN
RX 2 2 2 2 TD (BA)
TX 3 3 3 3 RD (BB)
GND 5 5 5 7 SC, CR, (AB) GND
RS232
RS232
97240 28166 (9pin, female/female, 3 m)

Fig. 2-35 CSB-Version, I/O panel on cabinet top, RS 232 connection CVOR/DME

Ed. 01.02 2-43


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

Shelter 97240 28168


RS 232

24009 28148
ID

LGM2 DME-IDENT

DME
(FSD 40/45)

VOR (SK26)

Adapter

CVOR IOM
AUX 1

(IOM-Version)

Fig. 2-36 IOM-Version, connector panel at cabinet rear side, connection CVOR to DME

CVOR 431 DME FSD 40/45


connector DME-IDENT connector VOR(SK26)
37pin, male 25pin, female
SIGNAL NAME PIN PIN SIGNAL NAME
DME-ID 16 16 4 4 MORCO
DMOVS 18 18 6 6 BCNFTY
GNDDME 19 19 24 24 SIGNAL GND
37 37 3 3 SIGNAL GND
U15+ 33 5 5 SIGNAL GND
VOR OP 36 36 25 25 AFFTY
24V ID 34 34 12 12 +24V
DMSL 35 35
DMSR 17 17
1 kOhm
24009 28148 (AF cable)

Fig. 2-37 IOM-Version, connector panel at cabinet rear side, ident connection CVOR/DME

CVOR 431 DME FSD 40/45


connector LGM2 connector AUX1
9pin, male 25pin, male
97243 28214
(Adapter, female/female) PIN SIGNAL NAME
SIGNAL NAME PIN
RX 2 2 2 2 TD (BA)
TX 3 3 3 3 RD (BB)
GND 5 5 5 7 SC, CR, (AB) GND
RS232
RS232
97240 28168 (9pin, female/male, 5 m)

Fig. 2-38 IOM-Version, connector panel at cabinet rear side, RS 232 connection CVOR/DME

2-44 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation

Shelter
97240 28168
RS 232

24009 28148
ID

LGM2 DME-IDENT

Adapter

IOM
AUX 1

TACAN
(FTA 43)

VOR (SK3)

SK6
(ELTA connection)
CVOR

Fig. 2-39 Cable connection CVOR to TACAN

CVOR 431 TACAN FTA 43


connector DME-IDENT connector VOR(SK3)
37pin, male 25pin, female
SIGNAL NAME PIN PIN SIGNAL NAME
DME-ID 16 16 4 4 MORCO
DMOVS 18 18 6 6 BCNFTY
GNDDME 19 19 24 24 SIGNAL GND
37 37 3 3 SIGNAL GND
U15+ 33 5 5 SIGNAL GND
VOR OP 36 36 25 25 AFFTY
24V ID 34 34 12 12 +24V
DMSL 35 35
DMSR 17 17
1 kOhm
24009 28148 (AF cable)

Fig. 2-40 Ident connection CVOR/TACAN

CVOR 431 TACAN FTA 43,


connector LGM2 connector AUX1
9pin, male 25pin, male
97243 28214
(Adapter, female/female)
PIN SIGNAL NAME
SIGNAL NAME PIN
RX 2 2 2 2 TD (BA)
TX 3 3 3 3 RD (BB)
GND 5 5 5 7 SC, CR, (AB) GND
RS232
RS232
97240 28168 (9pin, female/male, 5 m)

Fig. 2-41 RS 232-connection CVOR/TACAN

Ed. 01.02 2-45


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

Shelter
alternativ

ext. Modem

LGM 1200
DME DME

Modem
FSD 40/45 FSD 40/45 CVOR 431
(CSB-Version) (CSB-Version)

RS 232
IFV LGM1
IFV PL2 3) (SK10)
PL7
2)
DME-IDENT
(SK10)
1)
24009 28148
ID

AF distribution box

placing at disposal by the


1) airport
LGM1
1 1 La
1a
2 2 Lb
1b
3 3 PL7
. . La AF distribution box
. . 1 1 2a
Lb
9 6 6 2b
9
Tower
4)
AF distribution box
9 9
terminal bar
(connection example) RCSE 443
Note: 2)
1) Line connection (2-wire to SubD 9pin connector) for connection to LGM1, assembled on site
2) Line connection (2-wire to SubD 9pin connector) for connection to PL7, assembled on site
3) Connection of 2-wire line according to modem documentation, assembled on site
4) Connection refer to Technical Manual of RCSE 443

Fig. 2-42 Cable connections to CVOR and DME 40/45 (DME with individual internal or
external modem for RC connection)
Shelter
alternativ
ext. Modem

LGM 1200

TACAN TACAN
Modem

FTA 43 FTA 43 CVOR 431


RS 232

VOR VOR LGM1


(SK3) AUX 1 3) (SK3)
SK2
2)
DME-IDENT

1)
24009 28148
ID

AF distribution box

placing at disposal by the


1) airport
LGM1
1 1 La
1a
2 2 Lb
1b
3 3 SK2
. . La AF distribution box
. . 1 1 2a
Lb
6 6 2b
9 9 Tower
4)
AF distribution box
9 9 terminal bar
(connection example) RCSE 443
Note: 2)
1) Line connection (2-wire to SubD 9pin connector) for connection to LGM1, assembled on site
2) Line connection (2-wire to SubD 9pin connector) for connection to SK2, assembled on site
3) Connection of 2-wire line according to modem documentation, assembled on site
4) Connection refer to Technical Manual of RCSE 443

Fig. 2-43 Cable connections to CVOR and TACAN (TACAN with individual internal or
external modem for RC connection)

2-46 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation
2.6.4 Connection of DME 415/435 to CVOR 431
2.6.4.1 Ident and RS232 connection
See Fig. 2-44 to 2-46
- Lay the ID-cable (Ref. No. 24009 28149) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the connector
SK4/AF1 on top of the DME cabinet and to connector DME-IDENT on top of the CVOR/DVOR
cabinet (Fig. 2-44 and 2-45).
- To establish the RS 232 connection plug adapter Ref.No. 97243 28211 (Fig. 2-44 and 2-46) to
connector PL1/Port 3 on top of the DME cabinet.
- Place the RS 232-cable (Ref.No. 97240 28166) in the shelter cable duct. Connect it to the adapter
(on top of DME cabinet) and to connector LGM2/DME on top of the CVOR/DVOR cabinet.

NOTE: Ground (DME IDENT, Pin 19) is not connected to DME. Shielding of ID cable is connected
one-sided to DME connector ground.

The adapter 97243 28211 can be ommitted if a RS 232 cable is used with 1:1 through conĆ
nection (not crossed).

2.6.4.2 Configuration of CVOR 431 and DME 415/435


VOR 431, setting switches or jumper of CSL (Ref. No. 83134 23101, see Section 6.2.4):
- Set switch S5 to position ASSOC. (AN400 is Master) for the collocation with DME 415/435.
- Set X25 to position 2-3, DME-OP via signalling line.
- Set X11/X12 to position 2-3 (optocoupler only) as default for CVOR/DVOR.
- All other are set according default or normal position as shown in Section 6.2.4.

DME 415/435: Refer to Technical Manual, Ref.No. 8BR 02012 1000 DEGFA, Volume 1, Dec. 1998:

- Configuration of AFI: Regard that path M5, M2, M3 is set to "Internal Source" (delivery position)
- Enter in user SW program:
AF Status Low
ID Code/trigger from AF Low
DME Status Low
Morse Code Slave Trigger / Slave Code
Ident Recovery On Sensing

Ed. 01.02 2-47


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

Shelter 97240 28166


RS 232

24009 28149
ID
LGM2/DME
DME-IDENT SK4/AF1 Adapter
PL1/Port3

CVOR DME
415/435

Fig. 2-44 Collocation CVOR/DVOR with DME 415/435

CVOR 431 DME 415/435


connector DME-IDENT connector SK4/AF1
37pin, male 25pin, female
SIGNAL PIN PIN SIGNAL
DME-ID 16 16 1 1 DIDFAFL
DMOVS 18 18 4 4 DBCOKL
DMSR 17 17 17 17 DBCOKH
GND DME 19 19 1)
U15+ 33
VOR/LOC OP 36 36 2 2 DAFSTL
24V ID 34 34 14 14 DIDFAFH
DMSL 35 35 15 15 DAFSTH

NOTE: 24009 28149 (ID cable)


1) Ground not connected between CVOR (pin 19) and DME

Fig. 2-45 Ident connection CVOR/DVOR to DME 415/435

CVOR 431 DME 415/435


connector LGM2/DME connector PL1/Port 3
9pin, male 97243 28211
25pin, male
(Adapter, male/fimale) PIN SIGNAL
SIGNAL PIN
RX 2 2 2 2 TXD
TX 3 3 3 3 RXD
GND 5 5 5 7 PGND
RS232
RS232
NOTE: 97240 28166 (9pin, female/female, 3 m)
The adapter can be ommitted, if other RS 232 cable is used, which has no crossed lines between pin 2 and 3

Fig. 2-46 RS232 connection CVOR/DVOR to DME 415/435

2-48 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Installation

Shelter
alternativ

ext. Modem

LGM 1200
DME DME

Modem
415/435 415/435 CVOR 431

RS 232
LGM1
SK4/AF1 PL1/Port 3 3) SK4/AF1 PL7
2)
DME-IDENT

24009 28149
1)
ID

AF distribution box

placing at disposal by the


1) airport
LGM1
1 1 La
1a
2 2 Lb
1b
3 3 PL7
. . La AF distribution box
. . 1 1 2a
Lb
9 6 6 2b
9
Tower
4)
AF distribution box
9 9
terminal bar
(connection example) RCSE 443
2)
Note:
1) Line connection (2-wire to SubD 9pin connector) for connection to LGM1, assembled on site
2) Line connection (2-wire to SubD 9pin connector) for connection to PL7, assembled on site
3) Connection of 2-wire line according to modem documentation, assembled on site
4) Connection refer to Technical Manual of RCSE 443

Fig. 2-47 Cable connections to CVOR/DVOR and DME 415/435


(DME with individual internal or external modem for RC connection)

Ed. 01.02 2-49


CVOR 431
Installation Operation and Maintenance

2.7 INSTALLATION OF THE DME ANTENNA


See Fig. 2-15, 2-48.
The DME antenna is mounted on top of the CVOR antenna radome onto a special adapter (Fig.
2-15). Twin obstruction lights are part of the antenna. Refer also to the correspondent Technical
Manuals for DME FSD 40/45 or DME 415/435.

WARNING

Before connecting the obstruction light supply cable check that mains is switched off and
mains lead is dead.

obstruction lights

DME antenna

ANTENNA
connector

M1 M2

connectors

OL

Fixing device bottom view


connectors
cable through
DME antenna adapter
VOR antenna radome

Fig. 2-48 Arrangement and installation of the DME antenna (example AAN 96/86), principle view

2-50 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Operation

CHAPTER 3
OPERATION
3.1 GENERAL
Standard operation is normally carried out via a remote control interface with the user program AĆ
DRACS installed on a PC. For local operation only a few functions are operable with the local control
panel (LCP). It consists of a Local Control CPU board (LC CPU) and the Local Control Interface (LCI)
for main status indication, equipment status and measurement data and manual controls (switch
commands) for basic control functions. The alignment procedure and the maintenance are perĆ
formed with a locally connected PC.

3.2 LOCAL CONTROL INTERFACE


See Fig. 3-1.

The Local Control Interface (LCI) provides different indication and control components:
- three indication lamps for the main status of the system (ALARM, WARNING, NORMAL)
- a menu driven liquid crystal display screen (16 lines x 40 characters) for indication of station name
and type, status of monitor(s) and transmitter(s) and measurement data,
- four control buttons to perform simple activities like change-over or disconnect the transmitter(s)
- a key-lock switch to select different operational modes of the station, i.e. disable/enable local and
remote control of the station (REMOTE, LOCAL, MAINTENANCE); the actual mode is presented
on the LCD screen.
A serial connector RS 232 (Local PC) is located on the top of the transmitter rack to interconnect a
local PC/laptop. A test of the three indication lamps of the LCI is provided by pressing the two middle
control buttons simultaneously.
The meaning of the indications, buttons and the key-lock switch on the LCI is described in the followĆ
ing sections.

NOTE: A buzzer sounds for a short time whenever one of the control buttons is pressed.

ALARM MONITOR–1 NORMAL EXECUTIVE


main MONITOR–2 NORMAL EXECUTIVE
status WARNING liquid
AERIAL TX–1 ON
indication DUMMY TX–2 OFF crystal
lamps display
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL screen
OPER. MODE REMOTE

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA
REMOTE

LOCAL

key- MAINTENANCE
lock control
switch buttons

Fig. 3-1 Local Control Interface (LCI), example

Ed. 01.02 3-1


CVOR 431
Operation Operation and Maintenance

3.2.1 Indication Lamps for Main Status

ALARM red Monitor 1 and Monitor 2 are in ALARM state (i.e. relevant signals are
out of tolerance).

WARNING yellow The station is supplied by battery or


one or both monitor(s) is (are) in bypassed mode or
has a BITE warning.

NORMAL green All transmitter and monitor equipment is switched on, initialized and
serviceable for the intended category of operations (no WARNING
and no ALARM).

3.2.2 Liquid Crystal Display Screen for Indication and Control of the System
3.2.2.1 General Structure

The liquid crystal display screen is used to indicate the system status with details to the monitor status,
the transmitter status and the status of maintenance data (e.g. power supply). The actual selected
operational mode (set by key-lock switch) is also presented. Additionally the display screen provides
simple activities to change the system state by means of the control buttons below the display screen
and to present measurement data of the system.

After switching on the equipment a Welcome window appears on the display screen, where the operĆ
ator gets information about the actual system and where he can start the application (see section
3.2.2.2). After start of the application the System Status window appears, which contains information
about the actual system status and operational mode (see section 3.2.2.3). This window also provides
functions to the operator to initiate simple control commands (see section 3.2.2.4) and to indicate
different system data (see section 3.2.2.6).

The following example shows a System Status window for the Main Status NORMAL and the key-
lock switch set to state REMOTE.

MONITOR–1 NORMAL EXECUTIVE


MONITOR–2 NORMAL EXECUTIVE
system status AERIAL TX–1 ON
DUMMY TX–2 OFF

MAINTENANCE NORMAL actual operational


OPER. MODE REMOTE mode selected by
key-lock switch

–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Menu line with


MENU XMTR MON DATA meaning of
control buttons

Fig. 3-2 Liquid crystal display screen of the Local Control Interface (LCI), example

3-2 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Operation
The System Status indication comprises the following information:
Monitor status information of MONITOR-1/2:
NORMAL EXECUTIVE Monitor is executive in normal operation.
PREALARM EXECUTIVE Monitor is executive, corresponding transmitter TX 1/2 initiates a
pre-alarm condition in the Monitor.
ALARM EXECUTIVE Monitor is executive, corresponding transmitter TX 1/2 initiates an
alarm condition in the Monitor.
FAULTY EXECUTIVE Monitor is executive, Monitor itself has faulty condition.
WARNING BYPASS Monitor is switched to bypassed mode because of maintenance
purposes, Monitor is not in monitoring mode.
Transmitter status information of TX-1/2:
AERIAL ON The output of the corresponding transmitter (TX-1/2) is connected
to the antenna (and CSB- or SBO-power is not switched off).
AERIAL WARNING Transmitter BITE detects BITE warning in the corresponding trans-
mitter TX-1/2.
AERIAL OFF The output of the corresponding transmitter (TX 1/2) is connected to
the antenna (and CSB- or SBO-power is switched off).
AERIAL SHUT-DOWN Corresponding transmitter TX-1/2 is switched off due to monitor
alarm detection, TX is not ready for operation.
DUMMY OFF Corresponding transmitter TX-1/2 is connected with dummy load
and switched off via SW command, but ready for operation (after
switch-over command).
DUMMY SHUT-DOWN Corresponding transmitter TX-1/2 is switched off due to monitor
alarm detection, TX is not ready for operation.
MAINTENANCE status information:
NORMAL No maintenance alert, maintenance data is in valid range.
WARNING Maintenance alert, i.e. problems during configuration or power
supply problems.

The actual operational mode (on display screen 'OPER. MODE') selected by the key-lock switch
may have the following states:
REMOTE The equipment is operating in REMOTE mode (i.e. no local control
on LCP). Data can be requested from the PC connected with remote
control (RMMC) or from local PC, the programming of the station via
local or remote PC is possible (if user login level is high enough).
LOCAL The equipment is operating in LOCAL mode. Data can be requested
from remote control side (RMMC), but not programmed. This is only
possible by local PC.
MAINTENANCE * The equipment is locked (indication MAINTENANCE). This opera-
tional state is similar to the REMOTE mode, except that no data
programming is possible and the set of equipment operational
controls is the bare minimum needed for control tower personnel
to manipulate the equipment (e.g. transmitter on/off).

* on some LCP front panels LOCK instead of MAINTENANCE is used

Ed. 01.02 3-3


CVOR 431
Operation Operation and Maintenance

3.2.2.2 Welcome Window


After switching on the equipment the following Welcome window appears on the display screen:

ALARM WELCOME TO THALES ATM NAVIGATION

WARNING
ACTUAL INSTALLATION:

CVOR 431 100W DUAL


NORMAL STATION: VOR_SITE

SELECT MENU FOR START


––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU

Fig. 3-3 Welcome window, example

For the Welcome window the following control button is available:


MENU Start of application.
After pressing the MENU control button the System Status window (see Fig. 3-4) appears.

3.2.2.3 System Status Windows


A System Status window contains information about the status of the monitor(s) and the transmitter(s)
and about the status of maintenance data. It also indicates the actual operational mode, which is set
by the key-lock switch (see section 3.2.3).
For the System Status window the following control buttons are available:
MENU Calls submenu MENU LIST for selection of one of the control or data indication
submenus.
XMTR Calls submenu TRANSMITTER CONTROLS for selection of a certain transmitter
command.
MON Calls submenu MONITOR CONTROLS for selection of a certain monitor bypass
command.
DATA Calls indication MONITOR DATA .
This section gives an overview of different System Status windows depending on the actual Main StaĆ
tus of the system. The different states of monitors, transmitters, maintenance data and of the operaĆ
tional mode are described in section 3.2.2.1.

The following example of a System Status window with Main Status NORMAL indicates that both monĆ
itors are executive in normal operation. The output of the transmitter TX-1 is connected to the anĆ
tenna (and CSB- or SBA/SBB-power is not switched off) and transmitter TX-2 is connected with
dummy load and switched off via SW command, but ready for operation. No maintenance alert exists
and the actual operational mode is set by key-lock switch to REMOTE mode.

3-4 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Operation

ALARM

MONITOR–1 NORMAL EXECUTIVE


WARNING MONITOR–2 NORMAL EXECUTIVE

AERIAL TX–1 ON
DUMMY TX–2 OFF
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE REMOTE

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA

Fig. 3-4 System Status window with status 'NORMAL', example

The following example of a System Status window with Main Status ALARM indicates that both moniĆ
tors are executive, the aerial transmitter TX-2 initiated an alarm condition before it was shut-down
by the monitor and the standby transmitter TX-1 was already shut-down (not ready for operation).
No maintenance alert exists and the actual operational mode is set by key-lock switch to REMOTE
mode.

ALARM

MONITOR–1 ALARM EXECUTIVE


WARNING MONITOR–2 ALARM EXECUTIVE

AERIAL TX–2 SHUT–DOWN


DUMMY TX–1 SHUT–DOWN
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE REMOTE

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA = sparkling indication

Fig. 3-5 System Status window with status 'ALARM', both transmitters are switched off
(shut down), example

Ed. 01.02 3-5


CVOR 431
Operation Operation and Maintenance
The following examples 1,2 and 3 of System Status windows with Main Status WARNING present difĆ
ferent causes for WARNING condition with the corresponding states for monitors and transmitters.
The causes are added as comments in italic letters on the right side of each System Status window.
For the detailed description of the states see section 3.2.2.1.

ALARM

MONITOR–1 PREALARM EXECUTIVE Warning status


because of pre-alarm
WARNING MONITOR–2 NORMAL EXECUTIVE

AERIAL TX–1 ON
DUMMY TX–2 OFF
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE REMOTE

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA = sparkling indication

ALARM

MONITOR–1 NORMAL EXECUTIVE


WARNING MONITOR–2 NORMAL EXECUTIVE

AERIAL TX–2 ON Warning status


because of switch-over
DUMMY TX–1 SHUT–DOWN to TX 2
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE REMOTE

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA

Fig. 3-6 System Status window with status 'Warning', examples 1

3-6 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Operation

ALARM

MONITOR–1 NORMAL EXECUTIVE


WARNING MONITOR–2 NORMAL EXECUTIVE

AERIAL TX–1 ON Warning status


because of
DUMMY TX–2 SHUT–DOWN shut-down of TX 2
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE REMOTE

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA

ALARM

MONITOR–1 NORMAL EXECUTIVE Warning status


because of
WARNING MONITOR–2 FAULTY EXECUTIVE faulty monitor 2

AERIAL TX–1 ON
DUMMY TX–2 SHUT–DOWN
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE LOCAL

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA

ALARM

MONITOR–1 PREALARM EXECUTIVE


WARNING MONITOR–2 NORMAL EXECUTIVE

AERIAL TX–2 WARNING Warning status


because of
DUMMY TX–1 OFF BIT alert of TX 2
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE LOCAL

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA = sparkling indication

Fig. 3-7 System Status window with status 'WARNING', examples 2

Ed. 01.02 3-7


CVOR 431
Operation Operation and Maintenance

ALARM

MONITOR–1 NORMAL EXECUTIVE Warning status


because of
WARNING MONITOR–2 ALARM EXECUTIVE Monitor AND configuration
(Monitor 2 is in ALARM
state)
AERIAL TX–1 ON
DUMMY TX–2 SHUT–DOWN
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE MAINTENANCE

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA

ALARM

MONITOR–1 WARNING BYPASS Warning status


because of
WARNING MONITOR–2 WARNING BYPASS bypassed monitors

AERIAL TX–1 ON
DUMMY TX–2 OFF
NORMAL
MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE REMOTE

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA = sparkling indication

Fig. 3-8 System Status window with status 'WARNING', example 3

3.2.2.4 System Control Windows


A System Control window provides functions to initiate simple control commands by actuating one
of the control buttons XMTR, MON and DATA or by selecting a control menu after actuating the MENU
button. The System Control windows providing the control commands are described within this secĆ
tion. Two types of System Control windows exist:
- the window TRANSMITTER CONTROLS with commands to switch a transmitter on/off/main or to
reset the transmitter,
- the window MONITOR CONTROLS with commands to set/reset the monitor(s) to/from bypass
mode.
For the System Control windows the following control buttons are available:
BACK Return back to System Status window.
↑ (up) Scrolling up within command list (actual position is marked with '>' ).
↓ (down) Scrolling down within command list (actual position is marked with '>' ).
ENTER Activate selected command (marked with '>').

3-8 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Operation

MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE LOCAL System Status window

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA

press control button


XMTR

TRANSMITTER CONTROLS System Control window


(transmitter commands)
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––

> SWITCH TX–1 OFF


SWITCH TX–2 ON actual transmitter state:
SWITCH TX–2 TO MAIN AERIAL TX 1 ON
DUMMY TX 2 OFF
RESET TX–1/2

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
BACK ↑ ↓ ENTER

Fig. 3-9 System Control window TRANSMITTER CONTROLS, example

MAINTENANCE NORMAL

OPER. MODE LOCAL System Status window

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA

press control button


MON

MONITOR CONTROLS System Control window


(monitor commands)
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––

> SWITCH MON–1/2 BYPASS OFF


SWITCH MON–1 BYPASS OFF actual monitor state:
SWITCH MON–2 BYPASS OFF MONITOR 1 BYPASS ON
MONITOR 2 BYPASS ON

–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
BACK ↑ ↓ ENTER

Fig. 3-10 System Control window MONITOR CONTROLS, example

Ed. 01.02 3-9


CVOR 431
Operation Operation and Maintenance
If the right control button ENTER is pressed in the System Control window of Fig. 3-10 the monitor
command 'SWITCH MON-1/2 BYPASS OFF' is selected (the actual command line is marked with
'>') and will be carried out immediately. The display screen indicates the System Status window again
(with the changed status of MON-1/2).

3.2.2.5 System DATA Window

If the operator is pressing the DATA button of the System Status window monitor data for MON 1 and
MON 2 is indicated (MONITOR DATA), see Fig. 3-11. Exit this window by pressing Back.

DUMMY TX–2 OFF

MAINTENANCE NORMAL System Status window

OPER. MODE LOCAL

––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MENU XMTR MON DATA

press control button


DATA

MONITOR DATA
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MON 1 MON 2
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––

RF LEVEL 98 % 98 %
AZIMUTH 357dg 358dg
30HZ AM 30.1% 29.8%
9960HZ AM 29.4% 30.4%
FM INDEX 16.0 15.9

–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
BACK

Fig. 3-11 DATA window to indicate monitoring data

3-10 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Operation
3.2.2.6 MENU LIST Window

The MENU LIST window (Fig. 3-12) shows the list of the submenus which can be selected for indicaĆ
tion at the LCP screen. If the operator is pressing the MENU control button of System Status window
a list of system control and data indication menus appears:

- TRANSMITTER CONTROLS (calls submenu TRANSMITTER CONTROLS, see Fig. 3-9)


- MONITOR CONTROLS (calls submenu MONITOR CONTROLS, see Fig. 3-10)
- MONITOR DATA (calls submenu MONITOR DATA, see Fig. 3-11)
- TRANSMITTER DATA (calls submenu AERIAL TRANSMITTER DATA, see Fig. 3-13)
- TRANSMITTER BIT DATA (not supported currently)
- MAINTENANCE DATA (not supported currently)

For the MENU window the following control buttons are available:
BACK Return back to System Status window.
↑ (up) Scolling up within command/data list (actual position is marked with '>' ).
↓ (down) Scolling down within command/data list (actual position is marked with '>' ).
SELECT Selects menu item (marked with '>').
For the control windows the following control buttons are available:
BACK Return back to System Status window.
↑ (up) Scolling up within command/data list (actual position is marked with '>' ).
↓ (down) Scolling down within command/data list (actual position is marked with '>' ).
ENTER Activate selected command (marked with '>').
For the data indication windows the following control button is available:
BACK Return back to MENU window.

MENU LIST menu TRANSMITTER DATA


––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– has been selected

> TRANSMITTER CONTROLS


MONITOR CONTROLS
MONITOR DATA
TRANSMITTER DATA
TRANSMITTER BIT DATA
MAINTENANCE DATA

–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
BACK ↑ ↓ SELECT

Fig. 3-12 MENU LIST window, example

Ed. 01.02 3-11


CVOR 431
Operation Operation and Maintenance

menu TRANSMITTER DATA


AERIAL TRANSMITTER DATA has been selected
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––

XMTR 1
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
CARRIER POWER 100W
SBA LEVEL 40.0%
SBA RF PHASE 102 dg
SBB LEVEL 39.5%
SBB PHASE 124 dg

–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
BACK

Fig. 3-13 Data Indication window AERIAL TRANSMITTER DATA, example

3.2.3 Key-lock Switch on LCP front Panel


With the three position key-lock switch in the left corner of the LCP the operator can select different
operational modes of the station, i.e. disable/enable local and remote control of the station (REMOTE,
LOCAL, MAINTENANCE); the actual mode is presented on the LCD screen (see Fig. 3-14).
REMOTE
The equipment is operating in REMOTE mode (i.e. no local control on LCP is possible). Data can
be requested from the PC connected with remote control (RMMC) or from local PC, the programĆ
ming of the station via local or remote PC is possible (if user login level is high enough).
LOCAL
The equipment is operating in LOCAL mode. Data can be requested from remote control side
(RMMC), but not programmed. This is only possible by local PC.
MAINTENANCE *
Similar to REMOTE mode, except that no programming of data can be made and the set of equipĆ
ment operational controls is the bare minimum needed for control tower personnel to manipulate
the equipment (e.g. transmitter on/off).
* on some LCP front panels LOCK instead of MAINTENANCE is used.

key-lock switch
MAINTENANCE NORMAL
REMOTE OPER. MODE LOCAL
LOCAL
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
MAINTENANCE MENU XMTR MON DATA

actual operational
mode selected by
key-lock switch

Fig. 3-14 Key-lock switch and indication of operational mode on LCD screen, example

3-12 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Operation
3.3 CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ON THE SUBASSEMBLIES
See Figs. 3-15 and 3-16.

The controls and indications of individual subassemblies are explained in the figures 3-15 and 3-16.
Specialities are explained in the following.

Subassembly CSL, TEG-operation (Fig. 3-16): BCD switch (red) Position 0 to F


The following signals are assigned to the switch positions in the CVOR/DVOR range:
- 0 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth= 0 degrees
- 1 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth= 45 degrees
- 2 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 % 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth= 90 degrees
- 3 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth=135 degrees
- 4 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 % 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth=180 degrees
- 5 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth=225 degrees
- 6 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth=270 degrees
- 7 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth=315 degrees
- 8 30 Hz AM, 0 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth= 0 degrees
- 9 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 0 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=16; Azimuth= 0 degrees
- A 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=15; Azimut= 0 degrees
- B 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=17; Azimut= 0 degrees
- C 30 Hz AM, 30 %; 9960 Hz AM, 30 %; 30 Hz FM Mod.-Index=25; Azimut= 0 degrees
- D Spare
- E Spare
- F Spare

Ed. 01.02 3-13


CVOR 431
Operation Operation and Maintenance

ÊÊ Ê MSP

ÊÊ Ê TXDA lamp

Ê
RXDA lamp
CPU live lamp, green

ÊÊ Ê
Modem*

Modem*

Modem*
ÊÊ VAM* Ê
MSP-1

MSP-2

ÊÊ Ê
--
--
--
LCP
CSL

pushbutton manual reset


DCC-05

ÊÊ
ÊÊ Ê
Ê morse code indication

ÊÊ Ê
earphone jack (voice, ATIS)

ÊÊ Ê MSG-C

ÊÊ
ÊÊ Ê
Ê
TXDA lamp, green
RXDA lamp, green
MOD-110**
MOD-110P/

ÊÊ Ê
MOD-110

MOD-110

DCC-MV
MSG-C
MSG-S

ÊÊ Ê
SYN

CCP

ÊÊ Ê
ÊÊ Ê pushbutton manual reset

ÊÊ Ê CPU live lamp, green

ÊÊ Ê
MOD-110**
MOD-110P/
MOD-110

MOD-110

DCC-MV
MSG-C
MSG-S

ÊÊ Ê
SYN

CCP

ÊÊ Ê DC/DC ok (LED)

ÊÊ Ê
ÊÊ
ÊÊ ËË PMM

Ê
ËË
ÊÊ
ËË
ËË
ËË
Ê
Ê
ÊÊ
ËË ËË Ê
ÊÊ
ËË ËË Ê
DCC-28

DCC-28

ÊÊ
ËË ËË Ê
ÊÊ
ËË
ÊÊ ËË
ËËËË Ê
ÊÊ ËËËË
ËËËË
Ê
Ê
ÊÊ ËËËË Ê
--
ACC

ACC
ACC

ÊÊ
ÊÊ ËËËË Ê
ÊÊ ËËËË Ê
Ê
ËË
* optional
front side
ËË ** 100 W version only

Fig. 3-15 Push buttons and indications on the subassemblies inside the rack (1)

3-14 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Operation

Key and test jack


PM1 test condition

ÊÊ
M1 modem operable
LGM
M5* comm. line subsystem

Ê ÊÊ
and RCSE operable
Answ. modem occupies line

Ê ÊÊ
PM1 Answ.
S1 DEE operable
M1 (M5*) S1

Ê ÊÊ
FKS8 connector

Modem*

Modem*

Modem*
VAM*
Ê ÊÊ
* LGM28.8D1 opt.5
MSP-1

MSP-2

Ê ÊÊ
--
--
--
CSL

LCP
DCC-05

Ê ÊÊ
LC-CPU

Ê ÊÊ CPU live lamp, green

Ê ÊÊ Reset switch

Ê ÊÊ
CSL

Ê ÊÊ
TX1 ON, yellow
pushbutton manual TX1on

Ê ÊÊ pushbutton manual TX1off


MOD-110**
MOD-110P/

Ê ÊÊ
MOD-110

MOD-110

TX2 ON, yellow


DCC-MV
MSG-C
MSG-S

pushbutton manual TX2on

Ê ÊÊ
SYN

CCP

pushbutton manual TX2off


BCD-Switch TEG

Ê ÊÊ MON1, Monitor Fault, red

Ê ÊÊ
MON2, Monitor Fault, red
Switch Assoc./Indep.

Ê ÊÊ
Ê ÊÊ
MOD-110**
MOD-110P/
MOD-110

MOD-110

DCC-MV
MSG-C
MSG-S

Ê ÊÊ
SYN

CCP

Ê ÊÊ
Ê ÊÊ
Main Switch NAV, TX1, TX2 on/off

Ê
ËËË ËËË ÊÊ
ON
PMM F2 F1
OFF
Fuse F1 T1,0H 250V; F2 T6,3H 250V

Ê
ËËË ËËË ÊÊ
NAV TX1 TX2

Ê
ËËË
Ê ËËË ÊÊ
ËËË ËËË ÊÊ
DC/DC ok (LED)

Ê
ËËË ËËË ÊÊ
DCC-28

DCC-28

Ê
ËËË ËËË ÊÊ
Ê
ËËË
Ê ËËË
ËËË ÊÊ
Ê ËËË
ËËË
ÊÊ
ÊÊ
ACC

Ê ËËË ÊÊ
+54 V available (LED)
--
ACC

ACC
ACC

test jack Uout

Ê
Ê ËËË ÊÊ
Ê ËËË ÊÊ
R32, fine adjustment battery
charging voltage

ÊÊ Converter on/off

ËË
ËË
front side
* optional ** 100 W version only
** optional

Fig. 3-16 Push buttons and indications on the subassemblies inside the rack (2)

Ed. 01.02 3-15


CVOR 431
Operation Operation and Maintenance

3.4 NORMAL OPERATION


3.4.1 Switching On

CAUTION

Never switch on the installation unless the antenna or an adequate dummy load is corĆ
rectly connected! Make sure that the switches on the AC/DC converter are in ON position.
After the alignment procedure is completed use the main switch NAV and then TX1 and/or TX2 on
PMM to switch on the transmitter. The indications on the control and status panel light up.

3.4.2 Change over from Remote to Local (on LCI)


To change over from Remote control to Local control use the key-lock switch of the local control
Interface (LCI).

3.4.3 Change Over to Maintenance Operation


Maintenance operation is only necessary when operational values have to be adjusted on the transĆ
mitter or when a maintenance check has to be performed. It is carried out using the maintenance conĆ
trol unit (PC).

3.4.4 Change over to Monitor Bypass


Bypass operation is only necessary when operational values have to be adjusted on the monitor. It
is carried out using the maintenance control unit (PC).

3.4.5 Acoustic Alarm


When one of the four control buttons of the LCI is pressed the acoustical alarm stops.

3.4.6 Monitoring ATIS or Voice


An earphone (600 Ohm) can be connected to a 3.5 mm jack on MSP-VD to listen to ATIS information.
(ATIS = Automatic Terminal Information System)

3.4.7 Functional Check of Indications


When the two middle buttons of the control buttons of the LCI are pressed simultaneously all indicaĆ
tions light up simultaneously and the buzzer sounds for optical and acoustical test purposes. Since
the monitor carries out normal checks of function and accuracy, the operation of the installation is
faultless when the liquid crystal display screen of the LCI indicates NORMAL. If however the display
screen shows WARNING or ALARM, a check of the installation via PC is possible if LOCAL operation
mode has been set by the key-lock switch on LCI.

3.4.8 Switching Off


Use the main switch NAV on PMM to switch off the installation. Switches TX1 and TX2 are used to
switch off transmitter 1 and/or 2. The indications on the LCI extinguish.
NOTE: The LRCI (LCP and modem) is neither switched off via the remote nor the local control
interface, so that it can receive switch-on commands as long as any of the switches TX1
and TX2 are on. Main switch NAV must not be off in this case.

3-16 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

CHAPTER 4
ALIGNMENT PROCEDURE
The alignment procedure of a CVOR including the general prerequisites is described in a step by step
manner starting with 4.1. The following list is a summary and also a detailed table of contents.
NOTE: The procedures if the eight point ground check option is used are described in an Annex
to this chapter.
4.1 GENERAL PREREQUISITES
4.1.1 Operation via Personal Computer with WIN ADRACS
4.1.2 Recommended Test Gear
4.1.3 Installation
4.1.4 Special Setups for Alignment without Antenna System
4.2 FIRST SWITCHING ON
4.2.1 Status of the System
4.2.1.1 Special Jumper Settings before Start Up
4.2.2 Switching On
4.2.3 Preparing the Installation SITE with PC and WIN ADRACS
4.2.4 Use of Main Menu Items and Adjustment Masks
4.2.5 Entering Station Configuration Data
4.3 ANTENNA ALIGNMENT
4.3.1 Mechanical Presettings
4.3.2 Matching
4.3.3 Decoupling and Circular Pattern of LR
4.3.4 Decoupling and Circular Pattern of UR
4.3.5 Fine Matching of Omnidirectional Radiator
4.3.6 Decoupling Dipole A - B
4.4 RF-PHASING OF OMNIDIRECTIONAL RADIATOR LR - UR
4.4.1 Test Setup
4.4.2 RF-Phasing of UR - Dipole A
4.4.3 RF-Phasing of LR - Dipole A
4.5 CALIBRATION OF MONITORS
4.5.1 Preparations
4.5.2 Calibration of Monitor 1
4.5.3 Calibration of Monitor 2
4.6 SETTING OF TRANSMITTERS AND MONITORS
4.6.1 Adjustment of Carrier Power TX1/TX2
4.6.2 RF Phasing (SB - C), 30 Hz AM and Sense of Rotation of TX1
4.6.3 RF Phasing (SB - C), 30 Hz AM and Sense of Rotation of TX2
4.6.4 Setting of TX1 and Monitor 1
4.6.5 Setting of TX2 with Monitor 1
4.6.6 Setting and Check of Monitor 2
4.7 GROUND CHECK
4.7.1 Preparation of Monitor 2
4.7.2 Error Curve TX1
4.7.3 Error Curve TX2
4.7.4 Resetting of Monitor 2

Ed. 01.02 4-1


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance
4.8 SETTING OF MONITOR ALARM LIMITS
4.8.1 Monitor 1
4.8.2 Monitor 2

4.9 BATTERY MONITORING

4.10 NORMAL OPERATION


4.10.1 Prerequisites
4.10.2 TX1 Main
4.10.3 TX2 Main
4.11 FLIGHT CHECK
4.11.1 Prerequisites
4.11.2 Correction of TX1 and Monitor 1
4.11.3 Correction of TX2 and Monitor 2
4.11.4 Adjustment of Monitor 2 with TX1/2
4.11.5 Check of Monitor Alarm Limits
4.11.6 Normal Operation

4.12 RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN THE MONITOR DISPLAY OF THE RF LEVEL AND THE POWER

4-2 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure
4.1 GENERAL PREREQUISITES
This chapter is a step by step field alignment procedure. It assumes that the transmitter cabinet has
been factory aligned and tested.
4.1.1 Operation via Personal Computer with ADRACS
A standard or Laptop PC is used to perform locally the first alignment of the installation. The PC should
meet the following requirements:
- Processor Pentium 90 or better (IBM PC/AT compatible)
- 32 MB RAM, min. 1 GB HDD, 3.5" FDD (1.44 MB), VGA adapter
- VGA color monitor
- Control via mouse or comparable pointing device
- two serial interface connectors available
- Microsoft WINDOWS 3.x, WINDOWS 95 or higher, WINDOWS NT 4.0 recommended
Usually suitable PC equipment is already available at site. Otherwise it can be delivered on request
as an option. The ADRACS operating software for the different NAV systems must be installed on the
PC system. The adjustment of the transmitter and monitor parameters is performed via this terminal
using the corresponding menu window. First the ADRACS software should be installed on the availĆ
able PC. For installation procedure refer to Section 1.4 of Technical Manual WIN ADRACS (Code No.
83140 55323).

4.1.2 Recommended Test Gear


- 1 Multimeter
- 1 Thruline power meter with 1 W, 10 W and 100 W probes, range of frequency 108...118 MHz
- 1 Attenuator 10 dB/10 W
- 3 Attenuators 20 dB/1 W
- 3 Terminating resistors 50 W/1 W
- 1 RF phasing cable, (55°/113 MHz), TNC (M-f)
- approx. 5 phasing pieces TNC (M-f)
- 1 measuring dipole with tripod and 2x 30 m RF cable
- Various adaptors N-TNC and measuring cables
- 1 Monitor Signal Simulator (Ref. No. 83134 31600) with UHF-attenuator 30 dB/100 W

4.1.3 Installation
Before operation, the system must complete as follows:
- Transmitter cabinet, installed,
- Power supply, installed,
- Batteries, installed,
- Antenna system and
- Monitor dipole, installed and cabling complete.
- Mains voltage must be in accordance with assigned input voltage range of BCPS
(nominal 115 to 230 VAC).
- Cabinet has to be fully equipped with all plug-in units.
- Jumpers and DIP-FIX switches of the pertinent pc boards (refer also to 6.2.4) have to be in accorĆ
dance with the system version. To enable battery backup on specific pc boards refer to 4.2.1.1.
- The ADRACS software has been loaded to PC (refer to 4.1.1).

Ed. 01.02 4-3


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

4.1.4 Special Setups for Alignment without Antenna System

If the alignment is carried out on dummy loads proceed as follows: Arrange simulator setup according
to Fig. 4-7.

If a Monitor Signal Simulator is available (for supply by Thales ATM, see Section 4.1.2) proceed as
follows, see also Fig. 4-8.

- Connect CSB-signal to CSB IN of Monitor Signal Simulator and terminate CSB OUT by UHF powĆ
er attenuator 30 dB/100 W.
- Connect SB1- or SB2-signal to SB1(2) IN of Monitor Signal Simulator and terminate SB1(2) OUT
to 10 W dummy load.
- Terminate SB1- or SB2-OUT via attenuator 10 dB/10 W with a 50 W/1 W dummy load.
- Terminate unused SB signal of CVOR cabinet directly by 10 W dummy load.
- Connect MON1- and MON2-connectors of VOR-cabinet with corresponding MON-connecĆ
tors of simulator. Depending on the RF level, connect an attenuator between the cables.

Then the alignment of transmitter and simulator can be carried out as described below with the followĆ
ing exceptions: Omit sections 4.3, 4.4, 4.6.1e) to j), 4.6.2.1, 4.6.2.4, 4.6.4.1a) to b), 4.7 and 4.11.

4-4 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure
4.2 FIRST SWITCHING ON
4.2.1 Status of the System
- Mains off
- Battery fuse switches open (used for emergency battery, battery fuse box, shelter)
- POWER-switches on BCPS (ACC modules, transmitter cabinet) in position OFF
- PMM: switches NAV, TX1, TX2 (transmitter cabinet) in position OFF

4.2.1.1 Special Jumper Settings before Start Up


Individual jumpers have to be set before the first switching on. These are concerned with the enabling
of backup batteries for non volatile memory (LCP, MSP-VD/1,2, MSG-C/1,2) and the emergency
battery management (CSL). The location of jumpers is shown in section 6.2.4:
- LCP: Set jumper X36 (enabling backup battery for RTC).
- MSP-VD (MSD-V8): Set jumper X7 on both boards (enabling backup battery).
- MSG-C: Set jumper X7 on both boards (enabling backup battery).
- CSL: Set jumper X18 (enabling cutoff for over discharge protection of emergency battery).
- CSL: Set jumper X22 (enabling automatic restore).
- CSL: Select minimal battery voltage with jumper X19,20,21 for standard over discharge protection.

4.2.2 Switching On
a) Connect PC serial interface connector (e.g. COM1) to connector Local PC on top of the cabinet
using an interface cable (zero modem cable).
b) Switch on mains and set POWER-switches of BCPS (ACC modules, cabinet) to position ON.
c) Close battery fuse switches (battery fuse box, inside shelter).
d) Set switches TX1/TX2 on PMM (cabinet, front side) to position ON.
e) Set main switch NAV on PMM (cabinet, front side) to position ON. During initialization of the LCP
a buzzer signal is set.
f) Switch to local control with the key-lock switch on the Local Control Interface (LCI).

Ed. 01.02 4-5


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

4.2.3 Preparing the Installation SITE with PC and DRACS


a) Switch on the PC and run WINDOWS.
NOTE: Installation and use of the PC User Program is described in the Technical Manual WIN
ADRACS (chapter 1, sect. 1.4 Installation, chapter 2, Use). It is recommended to become
familiar with the menus of the user program before performing the first set up procedure.
b) Click group ADRACS REMOTE in Program Manager window. Run ADRACS RC.
c) Perform login procedure at the PC. Acknowledge "User1, Level 5" with OK button.
d) Click screen button CONTROL in the start window.
e) Select FILE TRANSFER in menu REU OPERATIONS. Select COPY PC FILE.
f) Copy configuration files (*.SIT, *.LKE, *.PTT, *.OIO) from configuration disk to site.
Service activity only: Copy adjustment masks files for the first setup (*.mxn) from disk to site.
g) Click RESET SITE to activate entered files and data.
NOTE: The ADRACS RC program is closed due to the reset. It has to be restarted manually.
h) Run ADRACS RC again. Perform Login.
i) Click screen button CONTROL in the start window.
k) Select DATE TIME REU in menu REU OPERATIONS. Enter date and time and acknowledge with
button SetNew. Close Date Time REU window. Proceed with 4.2.5 c) or
l) Click EXIT to close program. The program returns to the Program Manager.
4.2.4 Use of Main Menu Items and Adjustment Masks
From the Main Menu in the Adracs RC program the items Commands (C) and Activities (A) are used
in the alignment procedure of the first setup. Individual adjustment masks are available in the ActiviĆ
ties item (see Technical Manual WIN ADRACS (Ref. No. 83140 55323) chapter 3, section 3.2) such
as:
- Configuration (CF) - TX/MON Settings (TM)
- Antenna Adjustment (AA) - Alarm Limits (AL)
- Monitor Calibration (MC) - Flight Check1 (FC1)
- TX1 Phasing (P1) - Flight Check2 (FC2)
- TX2 Phasing (P2) - Flight Check3 (FC3)
- Battery/BCPS (BAT)
4.2.5 Entering Station Configuration Data
a) Click group ADRACS REMOTE in Program Manager window. Run ADRACS RC.
b) Perform login procedure at the PC.
c) Click screen button SELECT in the CVOR status field. System Configuration window appears.
d) Select COMMANDS. Click Switch both TX ON and Set both MON Bypass ON.
e) Select ACTIVITIES in the toolbar and then 'Configuration'.
f) Enter station type, station frequency and identity morse code for both transmitters and monitors
in the TX1/2 and MON1/2 window.
g) Verify that the MON1/2-window single channel mode is off.
h) Select COMMANDS. Click Switch both TX OFF.

4-6 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.3 ANTENNA ALIGNMENT


4.3.1 Mechanical Presettings
a) Remove the two antenna radome shells from counterpoise.
b) Loosen the 8 screws at the antenna foot (accessible from inside the
shelter) to enable the antenna to be rotated.
NOTE: Do not remove screws.
c) Set length of dipole slots for correct station frequency according
to Fig. 4-1.
d) Set all capacitors (feeding capacitors CF and corner capacitors CC,
Fig. 4-3a) of both omnidirectional radiators for station frequency
according to Fig. 4-2.

4.3.2 Matching
4.3.2.1 Dipole A
a) Arrange following test setup:

Disconnect SBA and SBB feeder cables from antenna and


terminate SBB with 50 W. Connect CSB feeder cable via thruline
power meter with dipole-A input. Insert a 10 W probe, set for
reflected wave measurement, into Thruline power meter.
b) Rotate antenna, so that longitudinal axis of dipole A points into
middle of radome openings.
c) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

d) Set CSB power to 10 W at the power meter. A/AA T1 Carrier power


10 W

e) Replace 10 W probe by a 1 W probe and set to reflected


position.
f) Set SBA power to 0. A/AA T1 SBA power
level 0%

g) Set SBB power to 0. T1 SBB power


level 0%

h) Adjust all slots of dipole A equally for a minimum reading at the


Thruline power meter.
NOTE: Minimum < 0.15 W (> 18 dB matching).
i) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

Ed. 01.02 4-7


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.3.2.2 Dipole B
Connect CSB feeder cable via Thruline power meter with dipole B and
perform matching of dipole B as described for dipole A in 4.3.2.1.
NOTE: Rotate longitudinal axis of dipole B into radome openings.
4.3.2.3 Lower Radiator (LR)
a) Connect CSB feeder cable via Thruline power meter with LR input
of antenna. Terminate UR input with 50 W.
NOTE: SBA and SBB feeder cables remain disconnected and should
be terminated with 50 W.
b) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

c) Tune feeding capacitors CF (both same direction) for a minimum


reading at the thruline power meter.
NOTE: Minimum < 0.15 W (> 18 dB matching).
d) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

4.3.2.4 Upper Radiator (UR)


Connect CSB feeder cable via Thruline power meter with UR and
perform matching of UR as described for LR in 4.3.2.3.
4.3.2.5 Decoupling Dipole A - B
Perform here measurement of section 4.3.6 b) to f). Omit 4.3.6 a), g).

4.3.3 Decoupling and Circular Pattern of LR


4.3.3.1 Decoupling LR - Dipole A
a) Arrange test setup for level calibration according to Fig. 4-4.
Connect CSB OUT of cabinet via the power meter with 10 W probe
and one attenuator 10 dB/10 W and three attenuators with 20 dB
using RF measuring cable.
NOTE: Verify that CSB power is 10 W and SBA and SBB feeder cables
are still disconnected.
b) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

c) Set 'M1 AGC Adjustment' value to 'M1 RF Level' indication of 100 %. A/AA M1 AGC Adjustment
--,- %

d) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

e) Change test setup according to Fig. 4-5.

Connect CSB OUT of cabinet via Thruline power meter with 1 W


probe for reflected wave measurement directly to LR. Connect
dipole A to 30 dB attenuator to input of monitor 1. Terminate UR
with 50 W.

4-8 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

f) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

g) Tune for minimum RF-level reading (decoupling) by means of the


trimmers located in radiation direction of dipole A.
Minimum reading must be less than 30 %, i.e. decoupling >50 dB.

At the same time watch reflected signal on power meter. If reflected


signal increases tune both trimmers CF in same direction to keep
it below 0.15 W.
NOTE: For decoupling tune trimmers in opposite sense, i.e. one in cw-,
the other in ccw-direction. For measurement of decoupling, the
person taking measurements on the counterpoise has to move into
null of dipole.
h) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

4.3.3.2 Decoupling LR - Dipole B


a) Repeat 4.3.3.1a) to d)
b) Connect dipole B via 30 dB attenuator to monitor 1 instead of
dipole A.
c) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

d) Tune as described in 4.3.3.1g) using trimmers located in radiation


direction of dipole B.
e) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

4.3.3.3 Circular Pattern of LR


a) Add following the field measuring test setup, see Fig. 4-6:

Set measuring dipole on tripod (height: 2 m) about 50...60 m from


VOR shelter and connect it via RF cable with input of monitor 1.
NOTE: Terminate dipole A and B with 50 W.
b) Rotate CVOR antenna so that CF points in direction of measuring
dipole.
c) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

d) Set CSB power to nominal value. A/AA T1 Carrier Power


--- W

e) Choose RF level (of measuring dipole)


f) Set 'M1 AGC Adjustment' value to 'M1 RF Level' indication of 100 %. A/AA M1 AGC Adjustment
If necessary use 20 dB attenuator at monitor input. --,- %

g) Rotate antenna slowly one turn (±180°). Reading must not change
more than ±4 %, otherwise correct settings of both CC according
to Fig. 4-3. If settings of CC had to be changed, then correct CF the
same amount in opposite direction (from CC) for min. reflection
(< 0.8 W).

Ed. 01.02 4-9


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

NOTE: Tune both CC equally (same direction) and then both CF equally
(in opposite direction).

If corrections were necessary in 4.3.3.3g) repeat 4.3.3 until the reĆ


quired values for decoupling, circular pattern and matching are
achieved.
h) Reset CSB power to 10 W. A/AA T1 Carrier Power
10 W

i) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

4.3.4 Decoupling and Circular Pattern of UR


Perform for UR as described for LR in 4.3.3.

4.3.5 Fine Matching of Omnidirectional Radiator


4.3.5.1 LR
a) Arrange following test setup:

Close radome provisionally. Connect CSB OUT of cabinet via


thruline power meter with 1 W probe (for reflected wave
measurement) to input of LR matcher. Output of LR matcher
must be connected to LR. Terminate UR with 50 W.
NOTE: CSB should be 10 W at first.
b) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

c) Alternately adjust C1 and C2 of LR matcher for minimum reflection


on power meter.
d) Set CSB power to nominal value. A/AA T1 Carrier Power
--- W

e) Repeat matching (see c)) until reflected power is less than 0.05 W.
NOTE: Matching  30 dB.
f) Reset CSB power to 10 W. A/AA T1 Carrier Power
10 W

g) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

4.3.5.2 UR
Change CSB feeder cable via Thruline power meter to UR matcher
and perform matching of UR matcher as described for LR matcher
in 4.3.5.1.
NOTE: Output of UR matcher must be connected normally with UR.

4-10 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.3.5.3 Matching Device Input


a) Complete cabling between CSB OUT of cabinet, Matching Device,
LR and UR normally, but insert Thruline power meter with 1 W probe
for reflected wave measurement at input of Matching Device.
b) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

c) Set CSB power to nominal value. A/AA T1 Carrier Power


--- W

d) Reflected power must be < 0.8 W resp. 1.6 W, otherwise check


matching of individual matchers again (4.3.5.1 and 4.3.5.2) and
check cabling.
NOTE: Matching >18 dB. In 100 W system use 10 W probe if necessary.
e) Reset CSB power to 10 W. A/AA T1 Carrier Power
10 W

f) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

g) Remove Thruline power meter from CSB supply cable.


4.3.6 Decoupling Dipole A - B
a) Repeat 4.3.3.1a) to d).
b) Connect CSB OUT of cabinet via cable directly with dipole B.
NOTE: Verify that CSB power is 10 W.
c) Connect dipole A via 30 dB attenuator to input of monitor 1.
d) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

e) Reading must be less than 50 %. Otherwise dipole plates of antenna


have to be adjusted (nominal 90°).
NOTE: Measure with provisionally closed radome. Nominal decoupling
>45 dB.
f) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

g) Close antenna radome properly again.

Ed. 01.02 4-11


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.4 RF-PHASING OF OMNIDIRECTIONAL RADIATOR


LR - UR
4.4.1 Test Setup
a) Connect all RF cables between cabinet outputs, matching device
and antenna normally.
b) Rotate the antenna so that field-strength maximum of dipole A
points to the measuring dipole in the field.
NOTE: Verify that the measuring dipole is still connected to monitor 1.

4.4.2 RF Phasing of UR - Dipole A


4.4.2.1 TX1
a) Terminate LR output of coupler in matching device with 50 W/10 W
and input of LR matcher with 50 W/1 W.
NOTE: UR is radiating.
b) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

c) Set CSB power to 10 W. A/AA T1 Carrier Power


10 W

d) Set SBA power to 10 %. A/AA T1 SBA Power Level


10 %

e) Set SBB power to 0. A/AA T1 SBB Power Level


0%

f) Set 'M1 AGC Adjustment' value to 'M1 RF Level' indication of 100 %. A/AA M1 AGC Adjustment
--,- %

g) If the RF phasing of UR - Dipole A has to be done a second time,


continue with i) to j) and then with 4.4.3.
h) Choose SBA phase so that 30 Hz mod. depth becomes a minimum. A/AA T1 SBA Phase Adjust.
Change SBA phase by 90° and note down azimuth reading. --- °
Set SBA phase back to quadrature as before.
The next point is j).
i) Set 30 Hz mod. depth again to minimum by means of phasing
pieces at input of UR.
j) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

4.4.3 RF Phasing of LR - Dipole A


a) Connect LR path inside matching device normally, but with
additional inserted 55°-cable.
b) Terminate UR output of coupler in matching device with 50 W/10 W
and input of UR matcher with 50 W/1 W.
NOTE: LR is radiating.

4-12 Ed.1
Ed. 08.00
01.02
CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

c) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

d) Set 'M1 AGC Adjustment' value to 'M1 RF Level' indication of 100 %. A/AA M1 AGC Adjustment
--,- %

e) Set 30 Hz mod. depth again to minimum by means of phasing


pieces at input of LR matcher. If this is possible, continue with
point g).

If phasing pieces have to be inserted into the SBA dipole continue


with point f).
f) Choose SBA phase so that 30 Hz mod. depth becomes a minimum. A/AA T1 SBA Phase Adjust.
--- °

g) Change SBA phase by 90° and check that azimuth reading is the
same (±1°) as in 4.4.2.1h). If approx. 180° different continue with j).
Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

h) Remove 55°-cable, but leave added phasing pieces at input of


LR matcher.

If SBA phase had to be changed in point f), start again with 4.4.2.
i) Reconnect UR path inside matching device normally again,
but including possibly added phasing pieces. Continue with 4.5.

NOTE: The following steps should normally not be necessary. They are only perĆ
formed to ensure a correct rotation sense of the antenna, if there is a 180°
difference in step g).
j) Swap feeder cable from power divider J3 to matcher of LR with
cable (+105°) from power divider J2 to matcher of UR, but leave 55°
cable in LR path.
k) Shorten cable (105°) in order to achieve minimum 30 Hz modulation
(approx. 200 mm).
l) Remove 55° cable.

Ed. 01.02 4-13


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.5 CALIBRATION OF MONITORS


REMARK: This is done with the test generator on the CSL. Check position of
jumper X17: open = CVOR/DVOR

4.5.1 Preparations
a) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

b) Set test generator with BCD switch S6 (front of CSL) to position 0.


4.5.2 Calibration of Monitor 1
4.5.2.1 30 Hz AM Modulation Depth
a) Set calibration factor 'M1 Calibrate Mod. Depth 30Hz AM' to A/MC M1 Calibrate Mod.
'M1 TSG Mod. Depth 30Hz AM' indication of 30 %. depth 30 Hz AM
---

b) Set test generator to position 8: 30 Hz AM mod. depth has to be 0 %.


c) Set test generator to position 0.
4.5.2.2 9960 Hz Modulation Depth
a) Set calibration factor 'M1 Calibrate Mod. Depth 9960Hz AM' to A/MC M1 Calibrate Mod.
'M1 TSG Mod. Depth 9960Hz AM' indication of 30 %. depth 9960 Hz
---

b) Set test generator to pos. 9: 9960 Hz AM mod. depth has to be 0%.


c) Set test generator to position 0.
4.5.2.3 30 Hz FM Modulation Index
a) Set calibration factor 'M1 Calibrate Mod. Index 30Hz FM' to A/MC M1 Calibrate Mod.
'M1 TSG Mod. Index 30Hz FM' indication of 16. Index 30 Hz FM
---

b) Set test generator to position A: 30 Hz FM Mod. Index has to be 15.


Set test generator to position B: 30 Hz FM Mod. Index has to be 17.
Set test generator to position C: 30 Hz FM Mod. Index has to be 25.
c) Set test generator to position 0.
4.5.2.4 Azimuth
a) Set 'M1 Calibrate Azimuth' to 'M1 TSG Azimuth' indication of 0. A/MC M1 Calibrate Azimuth
---

b) Set test generator to position 0: M1 TSG Azimuth has to be 0°.


Set test generator to position 1: M1 TSG Azimuth has to be 45°.
Set test generator to position 2: M1 TSG Azimuth has to be 90°.
Set test generator to position 3: M1 TSG Azimuth has to be 135°.
Set test generator to position 4: M1 TSG Azimuth has to be 180°.
Set test generator to position 5: M1 TSG Azimuth has to be 225°.
Set test generator to position 6: M1 TSG Azimuth has to be 270°.
Set test generator to position 7: M1 TSG Azimuth has to be 315°.

4-14 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

c) Set test generator to position 0.


4.5.3 Calibration of Monitor 2
Repeat 4.5.2 for monitor 2.
Switch off TX1/2. C Switch both TX Off

Ed. 01.02 4-15


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.6 SETTING OF TRANSMITTERS AND MONITORS


REMARK: For the following 4.6.1 and 4.6.2 the measuring dipole must still be
connected to monitor 1. The CVOR antenna must be rotatable. See
Section 4.4.1. Use Activities window TX1-Phasing (P1).

4.6.1 Adjustment of Carrier Power TX1/TX2


a) Connect the power meter to the CSB output.
b) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

c) Set the CSB power to nominal value . A/P1 T1 Carrier Power


--- W

d) Measure the power.


NOTE: If there is a difference between the nominal power and the meaĆ
sured power adjust the power by means of R1 of the corresponding
Control Coupler (CCP-V) see Fig. 4-10 (BP-T, X16)
e) Switch on TX2. C Switch TX2 On

f) Switch over to TX2. C Set TX2 Aerial

g) Set the CSB power to nominal value . A/P1 T2 Carrier Power


--- W

h) Repeat adjustment d) for TX2. Adjustment at the corresponding


control coupler with R1.
i) Switch over to TX1. C Set TX1 Aerial

j) Switch both TX off. C Switch both TX Off

4-16 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.6.2 RF-Phasing (SBA/SBB to CSB), 30 Hz AM and


Sense of Rotation of TX1
4.6.2.1 Preparations
a) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

b) Set 'M1 AGC Adjustment' value to 'M1 RF Level' indication of 100 %. A/P1 M1 AGC Adjustment
--,- %

c) Set SBA to 0 and disconnect the feeder cable from dipole A. A/P1 T1 SBA Power Level
0%

d) Set SBB to 50 %. A/P1 T1 SBB Power Level


50 %

e) Rotate the antenna for maximum 30 Hz mod. depth reading.


The reading must be > 20 %. If not change RF phase.
NOTE: Range of values: 0...359
f) Rotate the antenna for minimum reading.
NOTE: Range of value: < 1 %
g) Set SBB to 0 and disconnect the feeder cable from dipole B. A/P1 T1 SBB Power Level
0%

4.6.2.2 RF Phasing (SBA to CSB) and


30 Hz Modulation Depth Setting
a) Connect the feeder cable to dipole A and set SBA to 50 %. A/P1 T1 SBA Power Level
50 %

b) Choose SBA phase in order to get a 30 Hz mod. depth minimum. A/P1 T1 SBA Phase Adjust.
. --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...359.


c) Add or subtract 90 to the value found in b) and enter new value. A/P1 T1 SBA Phase Adjust.
. --,- %

NOTE: Note value.


d) Choose SBA power so that 30 Hz mod. depth becomes 30.0 %. A/P1 T1 SBA Power Level
---,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...99.9. Note value .


e) Rotate antenna for 30 Hz mod. depth minimum.
NOTE: Range of values:  1 %
f) Set SBA to 00.0 % and disconnect feeder cable at dipole A. A/P1 T1 SBA Power Level
0%

Ed. 01.02 4-17


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.6.2.3 RF Phasing (SBB to CSB) and


30 Hz Modulation Depth Setting
a) Reconnect feeder cable to dipole B and set SBB power to 50 %. A/P1 T1 SBB Power Level
50 %

b) Choose SBB phase in order to get a 30 Hz mod. depth minimum. A/P1 T1 SBB Phase Adjust.
. --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...359.


c) Add or subtract 90 to the value found in b) and enter new value. A/P1 T1 SBB Phase Adjust.
. --,- %

NOTE: Note value.


d) Choose SBB power so that 30 Hz mod. depth becomes 30.0 %. A/P1 T1 SBB Power Level
---,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...99.9. Note value.


e) Reconnect feeder cable to dipole A and set SBA to the noted A/P1 T1 SBA Power Level
value again. ---,- %

4.6.2.4 Check of Sense of Rotation


a) Set 'M1 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM' to 30 % A/P1 T1 Mod. Depth
with 'T1 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM' 9960Hz AM --,-%

b) Set 'M1 Mod. Index 30 Hz FM' to 16 with 'T1 FM Deviation' A/P1 T1 FM Deviation
--,-

c) Rotate the antenna a few degrees counter clockwise (as seen from
above) and check that azimuth increases. If azimuth decreases add
or subtract 180° to/from the SBA phase.
NOTE: Note down new value.

4.6.3 RF Phasing (SBA/SBB to CSB), 30 Hz AM and


Sense of Rotation of TX2
Perform for TX2 as described for TX1 in par. 4.6.2. Then remove
measuring dipole. Use Activities window TX2-Phasing (P2).
NOTE: Switch off TX1 and switch on TX2.

4-18 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.6.4 Setting of TX1 and Monitor 1


4.6.4.1 Preparation
a) Rotate antenna so that each dipole (A and B) has an angle of 45° to
the monitor dipole, then secure antenna by screws again,
see Fig. 4-9.
b) Cable monitor field dipole(s) normally with their cabinet inputs
MONITOR 1 and MONITOR 2.
c) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

4.6.4.2 RF Level Monitor 1


a) Set 'M1 AGC Adjustment' value to 'M1 RF Level' indication of 100 %. A/TM M1 AGC Adjustment
--,- %

4.6.4.3 30 Hz Modulation Depth Monitor 1


a) Choose 'T1 SBA/SBB Power Level' so that A/TM T1 SBA/SBB Power
'M1 Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM' becomes 30.0 %. Level ---,- %

NOTE: 80...120 Factor= 30 % x 100 %/reading above.

4.6.4.4 Subcarrier TX1


a) Choose 9960 Hz Mod. Depth so that 'M1 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM' A/TM T1 Mod. Depth
becomes 30 % 9960Hz AM --,-%

NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.8.


b) Choose 'T1 FM Deviation' so that 'M1 Mod. Index 30 Hz FM' A/TM T1 FM Deviation
becomes 16. --,-

NOTE: Range of values: 0...25.0.

4.6.4.5 Azimuth TX1


b) Choose 'T1 Azimuth Alignment' to obtain an azimuth reading A/TM T1 Azimuth alignment
'M1 Azimuth' equal to monitor dipole location (e.g. 0 for north). ---,- °

NOTE: Range of values: 0...359.9.

4.6.4.6 Identity and Voice


a) Set identity mod. depth to e.g. 10 %. A/TM T1 Mod. Depth
Identity AM --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...20.0.


b) If applicable set voice mod. depth to e.g. 20 %. A/TM T1 Mod. Depth
Speech AM --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...40.0.


c) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

Ed. 01.02 4-19


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.6.5 Setting of TX2 with Monitor 1


4.6.5.1 Control of TX2 with Monitor 1
a) Switch on TX2. C Switch TX2 On

b) Switch over to TX2 C Set TX2 Aerial

c) Check 'M1 RF level'.


NOTE: Nominal value: 100.0 % (± 5.0%).
d) Check 'M1 Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM'.
NOTE: Nominal value: 30.0 % (± 1.0 %).

4.6.5.2 Subcarrier, Azimuth, Identity and Voice


Set subcarrier, azimuth, identity and voice of TX2 in the same way as
described for TX1 in 4.6.4.4 to 4.6.4.6. Continue to use monitor 1.

4.6.6 Setting and Check of Monitor 2


4.6.6.1 Monitor 2 with TX1 on Aerial
NOTE: TX1 is radiating.
Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

Switch over to TX1 C Set TX1 Aerial

a) RF level
Set 'M2 AGC Adjustment' value to 'M2 RF Level' indication A/TM M2 AGC Adjustment
of 100 %. --,- %

b) 30 Hz AM Mod. Depth
Choose 'M2 Calibrate 30 Hz AM' so that 'M2 Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM' A/TM M2 Calibrate 30HzAM
becomes 30 % ---

NOTE: Range of values: 50...200.0.


c) Subcarrier

ca) Check 'M2 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM'. If indication is out of A/TM M2 Calibrate Mod.
tolerance, use calibration factor Depth 9960 HzAM
'M2 Calibrate Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM' ---

NOTE: Nominal value 30.0 % (±1.0 %).


cb) Check 'M2 Mod. Index 30 Hz FM' If indication is out of A/TM M2 Calibrate Mod.
tolerance, use calibration factor Index 30 Hz FM
'M2 Calibrate Mod. Index 30 Hz FM' --,-

NOTE: Nominal value 16.0 (±0.5)

4-20 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

d) Azimuth

Check 'M2 Azimuth'. If indication is out of tolerance, use A/TM M2 Calibrate Azimuth
'M2 Calibrate Azimuth' ---,- °

NOTE: Nominal value: same as in 4.6.4.5b) (±0.2)


e) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

4.6.6.2 Monitor 2 with TX2 on Aerial


a) Switch on TX2. C Switch TX2 On

b) Switch over to TX2 C Set TX2 Aerial

c) Check following monitor 2 indications: A/TM

ca) RF level 'M2 RF Level'

cb) 30 Hz AM mod. depth 'M2 Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM'

cc) 9960 Hz mod. depth 'M2 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM'

cd) 30 Hz FM mod. index 'M2 Mod. Index 30 Hz FM'

ce) Azimuth
NOTE: Nominal values: ca) 100,0 % (±5.0 %)
cb) 30,0 % (±1.0 %)
cc) 30,0 % (±1.0 %)
cd) 16,0 (±0.5)
ce) same as in 4.6.4.5b), (±0.2)
c) Switch off TX2. C Switch TX2 Off

Ed. 01.02 4-21


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.7 GROUND CHECK


4.7.1 Preparation of Monitor 2
a) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

b) Choose AGC value of monitor 2 'M2 AGC Adjustment' and note A/TM
value.
NOTE: Important for 4.7.4b)
c) Choose Azimuth offset 'M2 Calibrate Azimuth' of monitor 2 and note A/TM
value.
NOTE: Important for 4.7.4c)
4.7.2 Error Curve TX1
NOTE: TX1 is radiating.
a) Hang portable monitor dipole in 0°-position at the counterpoise
edge. Connect its cable with input of monitor 2.
NOTE: - Terminate disconnected cable at monitor 2 input with 50 W.

- Positions are marked on the lower side of the counterpoise.


b) Choose 'M2 AGC Adjustment' value to 'M2 RF Level' indication A/TM M2 AGC Adjustment
of 100 % ---,- %

c) Choose 'M2 Calibrate Azimuth' value to 'M2 Azimuth' indication A/TM M2 Calibrate Azimuth
of 0.0 °. --,- °

NOTE: Range of values: 355.1...4.9.


d) Record reading on a test sheet as 1st value.
e) Hang portable monitor dipole in 20°-position of counterpoise
edge and record reading as 2nd value.
f) Continue this way until all 18 measuring values have been recorded.
The measured values have to increment in steps of 20°. Differences
to these nominal values have to be considered as an error.
The error spread should be < ±2°.

4.7.3 Error Curve TX2


NOTE: TX2 is radiating.
Perform the error-curve check for TX2 in the same way as described
for TX1 in 4.7.1.

4.7.4 Resetting of Monitor 2


a) Connect monitor 2 input to fixed monitor dipole normally again.
b) Key in AGC value noted in 4.7.1b) again. A/TM M2 AGC Adjustment
---,- %

NOTE: Verify that RF level reading is 100 % again.


c) Key in Azimuth Offset noted in 4.7.1c) again. A/TM M2 Calibrate Azimuth
--,- °

4-22 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.8 SETTING OF MONITOR ALARM LIMITS


4.8.1 Monitor 1
4.8.1.1 Azimuth
a) Choose azimuth value (equal to azimuth value of monitor dipole).
b) Upper limit: Add 1.0° to indication and key in this value. A/AL M1 Azimuth Upper
Limit ---,- °

c) Lower limit: Subtract 1.0° from indication and key in this value. A/AL M1 Azimuth Lower
Limit ---,- °
NOTE: Range of values: 0...359.9;
If during flight check azimuth of transmitters has to be changed,
these azimuth alarm limits have to be readjusted.
4.8.1.2 RF Level
a) Upper limit, e.g. 123 %. A/AL M1 RF Level Upper
Limit --- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 71 %. A/AL M1 RF Level Lower


Limit --- %
NOTE: Range of values: Upper Limit 100...150, Lower Limit 50...100.
4.8.1.3 30 Hz AM Signal
a) Upper limit, e.g. 34.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth 30 Hz
AM UL --,- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 25.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth 30 Hz


AM LL --,- %
NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.9.
4.8.1.4 9960 Hz Signal
a) Upper limit, e.g. 34.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth 9960
Hz AM UL --,- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 25.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth 9960


Hz AM LL --,- %
NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.9.
4.8.1.5 30 Hz FM Signal
a) Upper limit, e.g. 18.4. A/AL M1 Mod. Index 30 Hz
FM UL --,-

b) Lower limit, e.g. 13.6. A/AL M1 Mod. Index 30 Hz


FM LL --,-
NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.9.
4.8.1.6 Alarm Delay
Set delay to e.g. 30 s. A/AL M1 Alarm Delay
--- s
NOTE: Range of values: 2...255.

Ed. 01.02 4-23


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.8.1.7 Distortion 30 Hz FM
a) Upper limit, e.g. 3.0 %. A/AL M1 Distortion 30 Hz
FM UL --,- %

4.8.1.8 Distortion 9960 Hz


a) Upper limit, e.g. 6.0 %. A/AL M1 Distortion 9960Hz
UL --,- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 0.0 %. A/AL M1 Distortion 9960Hz


LL --,- %

4.8.1.9 Identity AM Signal


a) Upper limit, e.g. 11.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth Iden-
tity AM UL --,- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 8.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth Iden-


tity AM LL --,- %

4.8.2 Monitor 2
Set alarm limits for monitor 2 in the same way as described for monitor 1 A/AL
in Section 4.8.1. Use adjustment mask Alarm Limits ( A/AL).

4.9 BATTERY MONITORING


NOTE: The floating battery must be installed and connected.
Use activities mask 'BCPS/BAT' A/BAT

a) Enter installed battery capacity. A/BAT Installed Batt. Capa


city ---.- Ah

b) When the Battery is fully charged, set 'Set Batt. Charge Level' to A/BAT Set Batt. Charge
the same value (Installed Capacity = Charge Level). Level ---.- Ah

NOTE: Divide Installed Capacity by 500 Ah. The battery is fully charged,
when 'battery current' indicates this value.
c) Check alarm limits (UL and LL) for battery half voltage, battery full A/BAT Batt. half Voltage UL
voltage and battery current. Batt. half Voltage LL
Batt. full Voltage UL
Batt. full Voltage LL
Batt. Current UL/LL

4-24 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.10 NORMAL OPERATION


4.10.1 Prerequisites
a) Equipment has been aligned according to 4.2 to 4.8.
b) Carry out 4.10.2 for TX1 as Main or alternatively 4.10.3 for TX2
as Main.
4.10.2 TX1 Main
a) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

Set TX1 to Aerial. C Set TX1 Aerial

b) Select function key 'Configuration' and check that no MONITOR


ALARM or BITE WARNING is on, otherwise click on the BITE
WARNING field (TX1) to get the list 'Checks on NAV-System' which
indicates all Alarms and Warnings.
NOTE: Allow system approx. 30 s for initialization.
c) Monitor 1/2 bypass OFF. C Set both MON By-
pass off

d) Simulate monitor 1 and 2 alarm by e.g. disconnecting monitor


inputs and check that after selected alarm delay TX1 is switched
off and TX2 is switched on. Remove monitor alarm conditions
immediately after change over.
e) Check that no MONITOR ALARM or BITE WARNING is on, otherwise
click on the BITE WARNING field (TX2) to get the list 'Checks on
NAV-System' which indicates all Alarms and Warnings. Locate and
eliminate fault.
f) Simulate monitor alarms again and check that after selected alarm
delay TX2 is switched off. Afterwards remove alarm conditions
again.
NOTE: Both TX must be off now.
g) Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

h) Monitor 1/2 bypass OFF. C Set both MON By-


pass off

NOTE: Check that NORMAL indication is on.

4.10.3 TX2 Main


Carry out 4.10.2 for TX2.

Ed. 01.02 4-25


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.11 FLIGHT-CHECK
The following describes a standard flight-check-procedure. However
range and sequence of this procedure may vary depending on the
individual flight check crew.
4.11.1 Prerequisites
a) System has been out of operation:
aa) Switch on all AC/DC-Converter
ab) Switch on fuse switches of batteries
ac) Switch on switches TX1, TX2 and NAV on PMM
ad) Switch on TX1/2 C Switch both TX On

b) System has been in NORMAL operation:


Switch on monitor bypass C Set both MON By-
pass on

4.11.2 Correction of TX1 and Monitor 1


NOTE: TX1 must be on "AERIAL", and both "MONITOR BYPASS" must be "ON".
PC is connected.

4.11.2.1 30 Hz AM Modulation Depth


a) Watch 30 Hz mod. depth indication: 'M1 Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM'
b) Change desired 30 Hz mod. depth with SBA/SBB-multiplier. A/FC1 T1 SBA/SBB Power
level ---,- %

NOTE: 80.0...120.0 = 30 % x 100 %/announcement of Flight Check EngiĆ


neer.
c) Recalibrate 30 Hz AM mod. depth for 30 %. A/FC1 M1 Calibrate Mod.
Depth 30 Hz AM
--,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 50.0...200.0.

4.11.2.2 9960 Hz Modulation Depth


a) Watch 9960 Hz mod. depth indication: 'M1 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM'
b) Change 9960 Hz mod. depth for desired value. A/FC1 T1 Mod. Depth 9960
Hz AM --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.8.


c) Recalibrate 9960 Hz mod. depth for 30 %. A/FC1 M1 Calibrate Mod.
Depth 9960 Hz AM
--,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 50.0...200.0.

4-26 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.11.2.3 30 Hz FM Modulation Index


a) Watch 30 Hz FM mod. index indication: 'M1 Mod. Index 30 Hz FM'
b) Change 30 Hz FM mod. index for desired value. A/FC1 T1 FM Deviation
--,-

NOTE: Range of values: 0...25.0.


c) Recalibrate 30 Hz FM mod. index for 16.0. A/FC1 M1 Calibrate Mod.
Index 30 Hz FM
--,-

NOTE: Range of values: 50...200.

4.11.2.4 Azimuth
a) Watch Azimuth indication: 'M1 Azimuth'.
b) Change azimuth for desired value according to announcement of A/FC1 T1 Azimuth Adjust-
Flight Check Engineer. Note azimuth indication. ment ---,- °

NOTE: Range of values: 0...359.9. Note new value.


c) Add 1.0° to azimuth indication and key in this value as upper limit. A/FC1 M1 Azimuth Upper
Limit ---,- °

d) Subtract 1.0° from azimuth indication and key in this value as A/FC1 M1 Azimuth Lower
lower limit. Limit ---,- °

NOTE: Range of values: 355.1...4.9.

4.11.2.5 Identity Modulation Depth


a) Watch Ident. mod depth indication: 'M1 Mod. Depth Identity AM'
b) Change Ident. mod. depth for desired value according to A/FC1 T1 Mod. Depth Iden-
announcement of Flight Check Engineer. tity AM --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...20.0.


c) Add 1.5 % to indication and key in this value as upper limit. A/FC1 M1 Mod. Depth Iden-
tity AM UL ---,- %

d) Subtract 1.5 % from indication and key in this value as lower limit. A/FC1 M1 Mod. Depth Iden-
tity AM LL ---,- %

4.11.2.6 Voice Modulation Depth


Change voice mod. depth for desired value according to announcement A/FC1 T1 Mod. Depth
of Flight Check Engineer. Speech AM --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.8.

Ed. 01.02 4-27


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.11.3 Correction of TX2 and Monitor 2


Correct TX2 in the same way as described for TX1 in 4.11.2, however A/FC1
set the 30 Hz AM and 9960 Hz mod. depth, 30 Hz FM mod. index,
azimuth, identity and voice mod. depth of TX2 in order to get the same
monitor indications as for TX1.
Afterwards the settings of TX2 have to be confirmed by flight check.
NOTE: Switch off TX1 and then Switch on TX2. Verify that both MONITOR
BYPASS are on.
4.11.4 Adjustment of Monitor 2 with TX1/2
Correct monitor 2 in the same way as described for monitor 1 in A/FC2
4.11.2, but 4.11.2.1 to 4.11.2.4 without b). Omit 4.11.2.6.
4.11.5 Check of Monitor Alarm Limits
a) The monitor alarm limits can be checked either by means of TX1
or TX2. The following describes this check by means of TX1.
b) Change of alarm limits - if necessary - can be carried out as
described in 4.8.
4.11.5.1 Azimuth Alarm
a) Watch azimuth indication: 'M1 Azimuth' and 'M2 Azimuth' A/FC3

b) Note azimuth value of transmitter: 'T1 Azimuth Alignment'


c) Upper limit:
Change noted azimuth value by approx. +1° until both monitors A/FC3 T1 Azimuth Align-
alarm. ment ---,- °

d) Lower limit:
Change noted azimuth value by approx. -1° until both monitors A/FC3 T1 Azimuth Align-
alarm. ment ---,- °

NOTE: Range of values: 0...359.9.


e) After check by Flight Check Engineer key in noted azimuth value
again, see b).
4.11.5.2 30 Hz AM Modulation Depth Alarm
a) Watch 30 Hz AM mod. depth indication 'M1 Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM' A/FC3
and 'M2 Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM'.
b) Note SBA- and SBB-values: 'T1 SBA/SBB Power Level'.
c) Reduce 30 Hz mod. depth by approx.15 % using SBA/SBB A/FC3 T1 SBA/SBB Power
multiplier until both monitors alarm. Level ---,- %

NOTE: 80.0...120. = Alarm Limit x 100 % / Indication.


d) After check by Flight Check Engineer key in noted down SBA/SBB
values again, see b).

4-28 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.11.5.3 9960 Hz Modulation Depth Alarm


a) Watch 9960 Hz mod. depth indication 'M1 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM' A/FC3
and 'M2 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM'
b) Note 9960 Hz mod. depth value of transmitter: 'T1 Mod. Depth
9960 Hz AM'.
c) Reduce noted value by approx. 15 % until both monitors A/FC3 T1 Mod. Depth 9960
alarm. Hz AM --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.8.


d) Upon completion of check key in noted mod. depth value again,
see b).
4.11.6 Normal Operation
a) TX1 Main C Set TX1 Aerial
or or
TX2 Main C Set TX2 Aerial

b) Switch off Standby TX2 C Switch TX2 Off


or or
Switch off Standby TX1 C Switch TX1 off

c) Switch off Bypass Monitor 1. C Set MON1 Bypass off

Switch off Bypass Monitor 2. C Set MON2 Bypass off

d) Switch to ENGAGED

Ed. 01.02 4-29


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Dipole slot length [cm]

30

20

10

108 110 112 114 116 118 f [MHz]

Fig. 4-1 Dipole slot length of CVOR antenna as a function of frequency

4-30 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

a) Trimmer (34-pitch, Voltronics QM10G)


25

20
Number of rotations

15 Feeding
capacitor (UR)

Feeding
capacitor (LR)

10 Corner
capacitor (LR)
Corner
capacitor (UR)

0
107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119
[MHz]
b) Trimmer (24-pitch, Stettner SQU110)
not longer used

15
Number of rotations

Feeding
capacitor (UR)
10

5 Feeding
capacitor (LR)
Corner
capacitor (LR)

Corner
2 capacitor (UR)


NOTE:
Piston fully turned out to stop=
minimum capacitance 108 110 112 114 116 118 [MHz]

Fig. 4-2 Adjustment of the omnidirectional radiator capacitors as a function of the frequency

Ed. 01.02 4-31


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

CF a) Position of trimmer capacitors

CC CC

Feeding points

CF

Measuring dipol

CF Ideal circular pattern

Measured pattern

CC CC

see A

see B

CF

A per +1% deviation: Turn CC -1/2 turn (ccw) and turn CF +1/2 turn (cw)*

B per -1% deviation: Turn CC +1/2 turn (cw) and turn CF -1/2 turn (ccw)*

* Set CF finally for min.reflection

Fig. 4-3 Alignment of circular pattern for LR and UR

4-32 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

VOR cabinet Power meter


(10 W) A B
CSB output
CSB-OUT

Probe, 10 W

MON-1
MSP 1
Adapter

D C

20 dB 20 dB 20 dB 10 dB/10 W

A, B, C, D: RF measuring cable

Fig. 4-4 Monitor calibration for measurement of isolation

A, B, C, D: RF measuring cable
UR

50 W

(Dipole B)

Dipole A
CVOR cabinet Power meter
Decoupling

(10 W) A B
CSB output
CSB-OUT
Probe, 1 W
LR

MON-1
MSP 1
LR

SBA
D (SBB)
C

20 dB 10 dB/10 W

NOTE: Test assembly for measurement of LR---dipole A (dipole B)


Test assembly for measurement of UR---dipole A (dipole B) corresponding

Fig. 4-5 Measurement of isolation

Ed. 01.02 4-33


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance
NOTE: The measurement is based on stanĆ Measuring distance 50...60 m
dard counterpoise dimensions with 5
m diameter and 2.5 m height. The diĆ Measuring
mensionsmay differ (e.g. 5...6 m diamĆ dipole
eterand2.5...3mheight)withoutsignifĆ
icant changes in results. Omnidirectional
radiator

Height measuring dipole: 2 m


LR (UR) SBA SBB

B
VOR cabinet Power meter
A
CSB output 50 W 50 W
CSB-OUT

MON-1 60 m cable
ÉÉÉ
ÉÉÉ
MSP 1 Attenuator

LR: 0 dB
UR: 20 dB A, B: RF measuring cables

Fig. 4-6 Measurement of circular pattern of omnidirectional radiators


CVOR cabinet

Mon. 1

Mon. 2
CSB OUT SB1 OUT SB2 OUT
*) *)
*) *)

50 W
Attenuator Attenuator Dummy load
100 W 10 W 10 W
-30 dB -30 dB

*) *)
*)
3 dB coupler

20 dB

20 dB

*) measuring cable

Fig. 4-7 Simulator test setup

4-34 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

SB1
LGM1 Local PC ASU DIAGNOSIS DME-IDENT

CSB LGM2/DME LGM3/NDB VAM ANALOG OIO LCP IN OIO LCP OUT

SB2

MON2 MON1
BCPS
TNC-connector

Transmitter rack
rear side, top view

optional attenuators
if need be

Attenuator Attenuator Attenuator


26 dB SMA connector 20 dB 20 dB
50/100 W* MON2 MON1 10 W 10 W

N-connector
MONITOR SIGNAL SIMULATOR N-connector
83134 31600

SBA SBB CSB

SMA connector SMA connector

* depends on RF level

Fig. 4-8 Monitor Signal Simulator test setup

Ed. 01.02 4-35


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

Monitor dipole 1

SBA SBB

Monitor dipole 2
(optional)

CSB-antenna

Fig. 4-9 Alignment of antenna

4-36 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Alignment Procedure

Local PC operation, via connector Local PC


on top of the cabinet

Ê Ê
Ê Ê
Ê X87 X86 X79 X78

Ê
Ê Ê
X85 X82
X94 X93 X92 X80

Ê Ê
control line BCPS
X77 X76 X84

Ê Ê
X99 X98 X97 X96
X73
BP-C X74

Ê Ê
X83
X95 -3 - 1

Ê Ê
X72 X71 -4 - 2

Ê Ê
Ê Ê
Ê Ê
Ê Ê
X70
BP-T X71 X84
X81

Ê Ê
X83
(TX1) X72
X85 X82

Ê CA-100/1*
Ê CCP-V

Ê X16

Ê
Ê Ê
X80

Ê Ê
R1

Ê Ê
X70
BP-T X71 X84
X81

Ê Ê
X83
X72
(TX2) X85 X82

Ê Ê
Ê
Ê
X16

X80 Ê
Ê
Ê
Ê PMM Ê
Ê
NAV, TX1, TX2
Ê Ê
Ê Ê
rear BP-DC
CA-100/2*

Ê
Ê Ê
Ê
Ê
Ê Ê
Ê
Ê
Ê Ê
Ê
Ê
Ê
Battery and power supply connection

Ê
Ê
Ê Ê
Ê Ê
control line BCPS
BP-BCPS

Ê Ê
Fig. 4-10 Transmitter cabinet, rear side, potentiometers on CCP-V

Ed. 01.02 4-37


CVOR 431
Alignment Procedure Operation and Maintenance

4.12 RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN THE MONITOR DISPLAY OF THE RF LEVEL


AND THE POWER
The CSB output power is displayed by the monitor as the RF level. This display does not correspond
to the direct power but is a voltage display. The power must be converted to a voltage in order to be
able to set an alarm limit, e.g. ±20 % power change.
dB= 10 log P1/P2 

V e.g. alarm limit for -20 % power change


dB =10 log P1/P2 ; P1 = 0.8 P2

dB =10 log 0.8 P2/P2

dB =10 log 0.8

dB =-0.9691

V e.g. alarm limit for +20 % power change


dB =10 log P1/P2 ; P1=1.2 P2

dB =10 log 1.2 P2/P2

dB =10 log 1.2

dB = 0.7918

Conversion of power change to a voltage change (U is used instead of V)

dB= 10 log P1/P2 ; P1= U12/R ; P2= U22/R (U is according to the RF-level)

dB = 10 log (U12/R) / (U22/R)

dB = 10 log U12/U22

dB = 20 log U1/U2

dB/20= log U1/U2

10dB/20= U1/U2

U 1= U2 x 10dB/20 
If the above  and below  formulae are combined the result is as follows:

U1=U2 x 100.5 log P1 / P2

The conversion yields the following relationship: U12/U22 = P1/P2 

These formulae can be converted to determine the associated power change from the monitor display
of the RF level.

P 1= P2 x 102 log U1 / U2 

4-38 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC

ANNEX TO CHAPTER 4
ALIGNMENT PROCEDURE 8 POINT GROUND CHECK
CHAPTER 1
CHAPTER 2
CHAPTER 3
The above chapters headers are used for numbering reasons only.

CHAPTER 4
FIRST SETUP WITH 8 POINT GROUND CHECK OPTION
This Annex describes the settings for the 8 point ground check (8 PGC) option during first alignment
of the CVOR installation which are different to those of the standard CVOR 431 without 8 PGC.

4.1 GENERAL
The following procedure is an excerpt from the standard Alignment Procedure. It is adapted to the
use of the optional 8 point ground check feature.
NOTE: The setup and alignment procedure which is described in chapter 4 can be performed
with connected 8 PGC monitor dipoles. The masks in ADRACS (see chapter 5) are
adapted for 8 PGC in a way that the standard monitor dipole, if used as before, is assigned
as main dipole (this is monitor dipole 1 of the 8 PGC option).
The differences in the procedure using the 8 PGC option are described in the following. 8 PGC adjustĆ
ments concern mainly section 4.7 Ground Check. The 8 PGC monitor dipoles 2...8 are assigned in
the correspondent calibration and measurement masks as dipole 045...315 according to the angle
distance of the dipole location related to the main dipole (or dipole 000). The manually performed
ground check procedure is replaced by the automatic ground check procedure with the 8 PGC opĆ
tion. All other standard procedures of Part 2 remain valid if no other proceeding is described.

4.2 FIRST SWITCHING ON


4.2.1 Status of the System
4.2.2 Switching On
The above chapter headers are used for numbering reasons only. There is no change due to 8 PGC.

4.2.3 Preparing the Installation SITE with PC and ADRACS


a) Switch on the PC and run WINDOWS.
b) Install new ADRACS SW version with 8 PGC option included. Refer to Chapter 5 of this product
info for remarks about differences in installation and use of the new ADRACS SW version including
8 PGC option.
NOTE: Installation and use of the PC User Program is described in the Technical Manual WIN
ADRACS (chapter 1, sect. 1.4 Installation, chapter 2, Use). It is recommended to become
familiar with the menus of the user program before performing the first set up procedure.
b) Click group ADRACS REMOTE in Program Manager window. Run ADRACS RC.

Ed. 01.02 A4-1


CVOR 431
Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC Operation and Maintenance
c) Perform login procedure at the PC. Acknowledge "User1, Level 5" with OK button.
d) Click screen button CONTROL in the start window.
e) Select FILE TRANSFER in menu REU OPERATIONS. Select COPY PC FILE.
f) Copy configuration new files (*.SIT, *.LKE) from configuration disk to site.
Service activity only: Copy adjustment masks files for the first setup (*.mxn) from disk to site.
g) Click RESET SITE to activate entered files and data.
NOTE: The Adracs RC program is closed due to the reset. It has to be restarted manually.
h) Run ADRACS RC again. Perform Login.
i) Click screen button CONTROL in the start window.
l) Click EXIT to close program. The program returns to the Program Manager.

4.3 ANTENNA ALIGNMENT


The following changes in the standard procedure text are to be regarded:

Section 4.3.3.3 Circular Pattern of LR (and following):

a) Set measuring dipole..., and connect it via RF-cable with input MON1 on top of the cabinet.
c) Switch on TX1.
Select station type standard CVOR (VOR Farfield [50] or [100 W]) in ADRACS:
"Tools" - "Adjust Windows" - "Monitor 1" - "Miscellaneous" - "VOR Farfield [50] or [100W]"

NOTE: Using the 8 PGC option there is no individual monitor signal input for Monitor 1 for TX1 and
Monitor 2 for TX2 on top of the cabinet as for the standard VOR. For 8 PGC the input MON1
is used for main dipole or monitor dipole 1 (monitor channel 0) which is fed via the MDS-
V8 to the Monitor units of both TX1 and TX2. With this monitor dipole input signal the installaĆ
tion is aligned as normal except Ground Check.

4.4 RF-PHASING OF OMNIDIRECTIONAL RADIATOR LR - UR


4.5 CALIBRATION OF MONITORS
4.6 SETTING OF TRANSMITTERS AND MONITORS
4.6.1 Adjustment of Carrier Power
4.6.2 RF-Phasing (SBA/SBB to CSB), 30 Hz AM and Sense of Rotation of TX2
4.6.3 RF-Phasing (SBA/SBB to CSB), 30 Hz AM and Sense of Rotation of TX1
The above chapter headers are used for numbering reasons only. There is no change due to 8 PGC.
Changes to the standard version start with the next section.

A4-2 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.6.4 Setting of TX1 and Monitor 1


4.6.4.1 Preparation
a) Rotate antenna so that each antenna dipole (A and B) has an angle
of 45° to monitor dipole 1 (Fig. 4-1). Secure antenna by screws.
b) Connect monitor dipole 1 (or standard field dipole) with the cabinet
input labeled MON1. It means monitor channel 0, used as main.
c) Switch on TX1.
Î
C Switch TX1 On

d) Select 'Adjust Windows' in the function key bar. Select window for
'MON-1' and 'Miscellaneous'. Set 'Station type' to 'VOR 8PGC Î MON-1
DVOR 8PGC [100W]
[100W]' and confirm.
4.6.4.2 RF Level Monitor 1, Main Dipole Adjustment
a) Set 'AGC Adjust. main dipole 000' value to 'RF Level main dipole' . A/ AGC Adjust. main
indication of 100 % dipole 000 --,- %

NOTE: Use masks "Adjust windows" "Monitor 1 Calibration" and "MoniĆ


tor-1 Measurement actual"
4.6.4.3 30 Hz Modulation Depth Monitor 1, Main Dipole Adj.
a) Set 'M1 Calib. 30 Hz AM main dipole 000' value so that indication A/ Calib. 30Hz AM main
'M1 Mod. 30 Hz AM main dipole' becomes 30.0 %. dipole 000 ---,- %

NOTE: 80...120 Factor= 30 % x 100 %/reading above.


It has to be regarded that the main dipole has a distance of 8 m,
otherwise the 30 Hz AM measurement is incorrect.
Values of dipoles 045 to 315 are informatively only.
4.6.4.4 Subcarrier
a) Set 'M1 Calibrate Mod. Depth 9960 Hz' so that 'M1 Mod. Depth A/ Calibrate Mod. Depth
9960 Hz AM' becomes 30 % 9960Hz AM --,-%

NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.8.


b) Set 'M1 Mod. Index 30 Hz FM' so that 'M1 Mod. Index 30 Hz FM' A/ T1 FM Deviation
becomes 16. --,-

NOTE: Range of values: 0...25.0.

4.6.4.5 Azimuth
a) Choose 'T1 Azimuth Alignment' to obtain an azimuth reading A/TM T1 Azimuth alignment
'M1 Azimuth main dipole' equal to monitor dipole 1 location. ---,- °
Determine azimuth location of the main dipole 1 (MON1) using a
compass for reading of value and enter value.
NOTE: Range of values: 0...359.9.

Ed. 01.02 A4-3


CVOR 431
Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.6.4.6 Identity and Voice


a) Set identity mod. depth to e.g. 10 %. A/TM T1 Mod. Depth
Identity AM --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...20.0.


b) If applicable set voice mod. depth to e.g. 20 %. A/TM T1 Mod. Depth
Speech AM --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...40.0.


c) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

4.6.5 Setting of TX2 with Monitor 1


4.6.5.1 Control of TX2 with Monitor 1
a) Switch on TX2. C Switch TX2 On

b) Switch over to TX2 C Set TX2 Aerial

c) Check 'M1 RF level main dipole'.


NOTE: Nominal value: 100.0 % (± 5.0%).
d) Check 'M1 Mod. 30 Hz AM main dipole'.
NOTE: Nominal value: 30.0 % (± 1.0 %).

4.6.5.2 Subcarrier, Azimuth, Identity and Voice


Set subcarrier, azimuth, identity and voice of TX2 in the same way as
described for TX1 in 4.6.4.4 to 4.6.4.6. Continue to use monitor 1.

4.6.6 Setting and Check of Monitor 2


4.6.6.1 Monitor 2 with TX1 on Aerial
NOTE: TX1 is radiating.
Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

Switch over to TX1 C Set TX1 Aerial

a) RF level
Set 'AGC Adjust. main dipole 000' value to 'RF Level main dipole' A/ M2 AGC Adjustment
indication of 100 %. main dipole --,- %

NOTE: Use masks "Adjust windows" "Monitor 2 Calibration" and "MoniĆ


tor-2 Measurement actual"
b) 30 Hz AM Mod. Depth
Choose 'Calib. 30Hz AM main dipole 000' so that 'Mod. 30Hz AM A/ Calibrate 30HzAM
main dipole' becomes 30 % main dipole ---

NOTE: Range of values: 50...200.0.

A4-4 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

c) Subcarrier
ca) Check 'M2 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM'. If indication is out of A/TM M2 Calibrate Mod.
tolerance, use calibration factor Depth 9960 HzAM
'M2 Calibrate Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM' ---

NOTE: Nominal value 30.0 % (±1.0 %).


cb) Check 'M2 Mod. Index 30 Hz FM'. If indication is out of A/TM M2 Calibrate Mod.
tolerance, use calibration factor Index 30 Hz FM
'M2 Calibrate Mod. Index 30 Hz FM' --,-

NOTE: Nominal value 16.0 (±0.5)


d) Azimuth
Check 'M2 Azimuth main dipole'. If indication is out of tolerance, A/TM M2 Calib. Azimuth
use 'M2 Calib. Azimuth main dipole 000' main dipole 000
---,- °

NOTE: Nominal value: same as in 4.6.4.5b) (±0.2)


Use masks "Adjust windows" "Monitor 2 Calibration" and "MoniĆ
tor-2 Measurement actual"
e) Switch off TX1. C Switch TX1 Off

4.6.6.2 Monitor 2 with TX2 on Aerial


a) Switch on TX2. C Switch TX2 On

b) Switch over to TX2 C Set TX2 Aerial

c) Check following monitor 2 indications: A/TM

ca) RF level 'M2 RF Level main dipole'

cb) 30 Hz AM mod. depth 'M2 Mod. 30Hz AM main dipole'

cc) 9960 Hz mod. depth 'M2 Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM'

cd) 30 Hz FM mod. index 'M2 Mod. Index 30 Hz FM'

ce) Azimuth main dipole


NOTE: Nominal values: ca) 100,0 % (±5.0 %)
cb) 30,0 % (±1.0 %)
cc) 30,0 % (±1.0 %)
cd) 16,0 (±0.5)
ce) same as in 4.6.4.5b), (±0.2)
c) Switch off TX2. C Switch TX2 Off

Ed. 01.02 A4-5


CVOR 431
Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.7 GROUND CHECK


NOTE: The Ground check procedure is automatically performed using the 8
PGC option. This is why this procedure is not performed manually any
longer.
4.7.1 Calibration Dipole 045 to 315 with TX1 and Monitor1
NOTE: TX1 is radiating.
Switch on TX1. C Switch TX1 On

Switch over to TX1 C Set TX1 Aerial

Use masks "Monitor 1 Calibration" and "Monitor-1 Measurement 8PGC" A/

a) RF level
Set 'AGC adjustment dipole 045' value to 'RF level dipole 045' A/ M1 AGC Adjustment
indication of 100 %. --,- %

NOTE: If need be use digital attenuator setting 'Digit.Ctrl.Atten.dipole 045'


Perform this also for the monitor dipoles 3...8 (... dipole 090 to 315).
b) Azimuth
Set 'Calibrate azimuth dipole 045' value to 'Azimuth error dipole 045' A/ M1 calibrate azimuth
indication of the main dipole 0°. dipole 045
--,- deg

Perform this also for the monitor dipoles 3...8 (... dipole 090 to 315).
Note: Indications values for '30 Hz modulation dipole 045' and dipoles
090 ... 315 are informatively only.

4.7.1.1 Check Calibration Dipole 045 to 315 with TX2


Switch on TX2. C Switch TX1 On

Switch over to TX2 C Set TX1 Aerial

Use masks "Monitor 1 Calibration" and "Monitor-1 Measurement 8PGC" A/

a) Check values for RF-level and Azimuth for the monitor dipoles 2...8
(... dipole 045 to 315).
4.7.2 Evaluation of Ground Check Measurement Results
The results of the automatic ground check measurement will be found in
mask "Monitor-1 Measurement 8PGC". These results are indicated as:
- Quadrantal error term sine
- Quadrantal error term cosine
- Duantal error term sine
- Duantal error term cosine
- Average error term
Comments to these indications will be found in chapter 5, section 5.2.5.

A4-6 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.8 SETTING OF MONITOR ALARM LIMITS


4.8.1 Monitor 1
4.8.1.1 Azimuth
a) Choose azimuth value (equal to azimuth value of main dipole 1).
Use average value of the main dipole 1 to define alarm limits.
b) Upper limit: Add 1.0° to indication and key in this value. A/AL M1 Azimuth Upper
Limit ---,- °

c) Lower limit: Subtract 1.0° from indication and key in this value. A/AL M1 Azimuth Lower
Limit ---,- °

NOTE: Range of values: 0...359.9;


If during flight check azimuth of transmitters has to be changed,
these azimuth alarm limits have to be readjusted.
4.8.1.2 RF Level
a) Upper limit, e.g. 123 %. A/AL M1 RF Level Upper
Limit --- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 71 %. A/AL M1 RF Level Lower


Limit --- %

NOTE: Range of values: Upper Limit 100...150, Lower Limit 50...100.


4.8.1.3 30 Hz AM Signal
a) Upper limit, e.g. 34.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth 30 Hz
AM UL --,- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 25.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth 30 Hz


AM LL --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.9.


4.8.1.4 9960 Hz Signal
a) Upper limit, e.g. 34.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth 9960
Hz AM UL --,- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 25.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth 9960


Hz AM LL --,- %

NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.9.


4.8.1.5 30 Hz FM Signal
a) Upper limit, e.g. 18.4. A/AL M1 Mod. Index 30 Hz
FM UL --,-

b) Lower limit, e.g. 13.6. A/AL M1 Mod. Index 30 Hz


FM LL --,-

NOTE: Range of values: 0...39.9.

Ed. 01.02 A4-7


CVOR 431
Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC Operation and Maintenance

Menu/
INSTRUCTION C: Commands
A: Activities Submenu

4.8.1.6 Alarm Delay


Set delay to e.g. 30 s. A/AL M1 Alarm Delay
--- s

NOTE: Range of values: 2...255.


4.8.1.7 Distortion 30 Hz FM
a) Upper limit, e.g. 3.0 %. A/AL M1 Distortion 30 Hz
FM UL --,- %

4.8.1.8 Distortion 9960 Hz


a) Upper limit, e.g. 6.0 %. A/AL M1 Distortion 9960Hz
UL --,- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 0.0 %. A/AL M1 Distortion 9960Hz


LL --,- %

4.8.1.9 Identity AM Signal


a) Upper limit, e.g. 11.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth Iden-
tity AM UL --,- %

b) Lower limit, e.g. 8.5 %. A/AL M1 Mod. Depth Iden-


tity AM LL --,- %

4.8.2 Monitor 2
Set alarm limits for monitor 2 in the same way as described for monitor 1 A/AL
in Section 4.8.1. Use adjustment mask Alarm Limits (A/AL).

4.9 BATTERY MONITORING


4.10 NORMAL OPERATION
The above chapter headers are used for numbering reasons only. There is
no change due to 8 PGC. Changes to the standard version are mentioned
in the next section.
4.11 FLIGHT CHECK
If during flight check the azimuth indication of the main dipole 1 has to be
corrected the other dipoles 2 to 8 are adjusted automatically according
to the changed value.

A4-8 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC

Monitor dipole 1 (0° reference)


(or standard field dipole)
(main dipole)

Monitor dipole 2
Monitor dipole 8

SBA SBB
Monitor dipole 7

Monitor dipole 3
CSB-antenna

Monitor dipole 6
Monitor dipole 4

Monitor dipole 5

Note:
Does an CVOR installation already exist the CVOR antenna has to be rotated in a way that the range distance
between maximum and zero of the sideband antennas is 45° related to the monitor main dipole 1.

Fig. 4-1 Alignment of antenna, arrangement 8 PGC dipoles

Ed. 01.02 A4-9


CVOR 431
Annex Alignment Procedure 8 PGC Operation and Maintenance

A4-10 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Maintenance

CHAPTER 5
MAINTENANCE
5.1 GENERAL
There are two basic types of maintenance, namely periodic maintenance and normal maintenance.
It is essential to ensure that the radiated signals remain within the fixed tolerances at all times after
the navigation system has been handed over for service to air traffic. With this aim in mind, ICAO recĆ
ommends verifying the most important signal parameters of the ground station within the framework
of periodic maintenance. In Navaids 400, all the main parameters are maintained at the preset values
throughout the entire life of the system by means of a microprocessor controlled transmitter, so that
drift as a result of ageing should not normally occur. In addition, the radiated signals are checked by
two high-precision microprocessor controlled monitors. These prevent fault signals from being
emitted by either switching over to the standby transmitter or shutting down the system completely.
Since, moreover, no parts which are subject to mechanical wear and tear are used, the periodic mainĆ
tenance intervals can be made longer than usual and the number of measurements restricted to a
minimum. Due to the measurement facilities which are integrated in the system, only a few external
instruments are required. In addition to the periodic maintenance tasks, there are a few activities of
normal maintenance which should be performed as and when necessary.

5.2 PERIODIC MAINTENANCE


NOTE: The items marked with an asterisk (*) are normally performed continuously via a conĆ
nected RMMC.
Compare also measuring values with those of recorded data (refer to section 5.2.4)
Handling with subassemblies regard instructions in section 5.2.1.
We recommend performing the maintenance activities listed in the table below once every month or
six months. The following measuring instruments are required for this:
- Personal Computer (Laptop or standard PC; used for maintenance on site)
- Headphones (600 ohms, 3.5 mm plug; for station identification)
- Portable field dipole
- RF terminating resistor (50 ohms, 1 W)
- Multimeter
- Battery maintenance equipment (acidimeter, acid syringe, areometer, thermometer, funnel).
No. Monthly maintenance
1 Check system status/visual inspection (refer to 5.2.2)
2 Check station frequency of former master transmitter*
3 Check station identification of former master transmitter*
4 Check settings of both transmitters and monitors*
5 Check measured values of former master transmitter and monitors*
7 Check switch over function by simulating monitor alarm and changing master transmitter*
8 Check station frequency of new master transmitter*
9 Check station identification of new master transmitter*
10 Check measured values of new master transmitter and monitors*

Additional six-monthly maintenance


6 Check ground error curve of former master transmitter (by use of 8 PGC option refer to 5.2.5)
11 Check ground error curve of new master transmitter (by use of 8 PGC option refer to 5.2.5)
12 Check remote control system (line loss)*
13 Check lead batteries/visual inspection (refer also to section 5.3.2 and 5.4, if need be)
14 Check battery function by simulating a power failure*
15 Clean all equipment thoroughly (refer to 5.2.3)

Ed. 01.02 5-1


CVOR 431
Maintenance Operation and Maintenance

5.2.1 Elimination of Static Charges

A grounding strip with a large cross-sectional area is connected between the shelter grounding terĆ
minal, the equipment racks and the worktable to act as the system ground and to eliminate electroĆ
static charges. It is firmly connected to the table and a grounding bus on the working surface. This
system ground should not be connected to either the mains protective ground conductor or to housĆ
ings and grounds of external consumers, i.e. consumers not associated with the worktable, except
at the potential equalization bus for the overall installation. The protective ground wire offered with
mains cable or plug connections is not suitable for potential equalization of equipment on a worktable.
Depending on local circumstances, it can carry quite high RF interference voltages. Mains-supplied
equipment, power supplies and test equipment should be connected via two-wire cables and two-
pin plugs.

For measures to be taken with respect to components sensitive to electricostatic charging (MOS, Low
Power Schottky) please refer to the customer service documentation of the manufacturer. If an emĆ
ployee is required to handle subassemblies for transport purposes, he should place both hands flat
on a grounded surface beforehand (e.g. on the ground bus of the work table). The module can be
picked up by its insulator immediately following this potential equalization. It is safer to avoid touching
the terminals. Only remove short-circuit links where absolutely necessary. Place printed circuit
boards only on tables with a conductive, grounded working surface. Leave individual subassemblies
in the antistatic plastic bags for as long as possible.

5.2.2 Damage check

The following system parts have to be checked visually for entirety:

- shelter
- counterpoise
- antenna radomes
- monitor dipole, monitor mast and cable
- fence around the station
- tight fitting of all RF cable connections (internal and external).
- tight fitting of all screwed connections (internal and external, electrical and mechanical).

5.2.3 Cleaning

CAUTION

Cleaning aids, such as brushes and dusters, must be made of antistatic material. See also
the instructions in Section 5.2.1.

- Shelter

Brushes, dusters and a vacuum cleaner should be used to clean the transmitter rack and the rack
for the battery-charged power supply. The transmitter room should not be cleaned with a broom,
but rather using a vacuum cleaner. The floor should be washed regularly every 6 month. The deterĆ
gent should be added in small quantities only to the water; no aggressive cleaning agents should
be used. Floor cleaning agents should be avoided, since these have the same effect as a dielectric
and encourage the build-up of static charges.

5-2 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Maintenance
If the floor covering is made of a conductive material, then similarly only those cleaning agents exĆ
pressly recommended by the manufacturer of the floor covering should be used.

The air filters of the fans, ventilation openings or air conditioners in the shelter should be checked
from time to time in accordance with the volume of dirt which accumulates at the particular location.
The filters should be replaced by new ones before they become clogged. If no new filters are availĆ
able, the dirt may - as an exceptional measure - be banged out of the old filter to permit the filter
to be re-used. Damaged filters on the other hand, should not be re-used. If an air conditioner
should become iced-up, switch it off and let it defrost. Observe the manufacturers maintenance
recommendations.

The separate battery compartment should be dusted out once a year. Avoid transferring dirt from
the battery compartment into the transmitter room.
- Transmitter rack
Only two types of alcohol, namely Ethyl alcohol or Glycol,or clean water should be used to remove
layers of dirt on the LCP panel. Check that key-lock switch is not in position LOCAL so that
unintentional control is avoided. Cleaning procedure: Moisten a cloth with one of the liquids menĆ
tioned above and remove dirt. Dusting of the subassemblies should only take place in conjunction
with removal of a subassembly when this becomes necessary in any case for some other purpose.
Even then, subassemblies should only be dusted if dust can be detected by means of a visual
check. They should always be dusted using a soft brush, and if possible with the aid of a vacuum
cleaner. During such operations it is essential to observe all precautionary measures described
in Section 5.2.1 for voltage-sensitive semiconductors.
- Antenna and counterpoise
The counterpoise, the RF cables, the ground wires with connections, and the antenna (PALESIT
seal) should be subjected to a visual check for corrosion and cracks at intervals to be determined
in accordance with the particular climatic conditions. In case of a heavy snowfall, the snow should
be removed from the counterpoise of the antenna. Air traffic control should be informed before the
counterpoise is mounted.

5.2.4 Documentation of System Data


The data recorded during the flight test is the only data which is binding for operation of a navigation
installation. It is advisable to check this data in accordance with the chart for periodic maintenance.
A documentation is performed by the printer of the connected PC or in a file for the transmitter data
and monitor data on the PC. The first data so-obtained of the basic adjustments of the alignment
procedure at commissioning and flight check should be recorded and stored in a reference file or on
a floppy disk. One hardcopy of the data should be completed with date and signature. The same proĆ
cedure should be followed when performing further checks, when the data recorded can be comĆ
pared with the original flight check data.

5.2.5 Evaluation of eight Point Ground check Measurement Results


The results of the automatic ground check measurement will be found in mask "Monitor-1 MeasureĆ
ment 8PGC". These results are indicated as:
- Quadrantal error term sine
- Quadrantal error term cosine
- Duantal error term sine
- Duantal error term cosine
- Average error term

Ed. 01.02 5-3


CVOR 431
Maintenance Operation and Maintenance

Error term Prealarm Cause Action


Value

Qs > 1° Bad quadrature of antenna pattern Change the antenna


Quadrantal semi cardinal
(sine) Bad quadrature between LF sine and
cosine signal
Qc > 1° Difference of RF level between side Check the SVWR
Quadrantal cardinal band sine and cosine (SBA and SBB)
(cosine)
If Qc > 0 then SBsin > SBcos Adjust the RF phase between
SBA and SBB
If Qc < 0 then SBsin < SBcos Adjust the level of the side
band to obtain the same level
Ds > 1° Zero of the pattern of the sine side Check the antenna
Duantal sine band antenna is not in a same line

If Ds > pattern of SBA > pattern fo SBB


If Ds > pattern of SBA < pattern fo SBB
Dc > 1° Zero of the pattern of the sine side Check the antenna
Duantal cosine band is not in a same line

If Ds > pattern of SBA > pattern fo SBB


If Ds > pattern of SBA < pattern fo SBB
Average error > 1° Bad adjustment of the phase between Adjust the phase or
30 Hz var. and ref.
Bad adjustment of the probes Adjust the probe position to
the good place

NOTE: This table shows the value for a prealarm threshold (alarm does not exist), the origine of the problem
and the possibility to repair, which are informative for operation and analysis.
The 8 point ground check analyses the drift of the bearing and gives the causes of this drift. This analysis
use the data coming from the eight probes arranged around the counterpoise. For each revolution, (8 points)
the monitor sofware calculates 5 parameters. These parameters allows to determinate the origine of the drift
(side band level, or adjustment of the antenna). It is possible for a specific application to put the probe at
20 meters around the station. The results obtained by the pooling of the 8 probes are similar. But in this case,
the 8 point ground check analyses the behaviour of the station and indicates if somebody or something goes
into the area inside the circle of the probes.
Description of the data: Each time the 8 PGC polls all the eight probes, the calculed azimuth of each points
is compared with the geographic azimuth of the probe. Each data is recorded by the monitor software and
5 values are caculated from this data :
Qc : Cardinal (1) Quadrantal error: Analyses the asymmetry between the levels of the sideband SBA and
SBB
Qs : Semi cardinal (2) Quadrantal error: Analyses the quadrature of the Sine sideband pattern (SBA) and
Cosine side band pattern (SBB)
Dc : Duantal error (cosine): Analyses the alignment of the cosine pattern.
Ds : Duantal error (sine): Analyses the alignment of the sine pattern.
Av : Average error: Gives the offset of the curve

1) The meaning of cardinal is in reference with the cardinal point (North, South, East West)
2) The meaning of semi cardinal is a same than cardinal but with a rotation of 45 degrees ( NE, SE, SW, NW)

5-4 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Maintenance
5.3 NORMAL MAINTENANCE
5.3.1 Replacing the Lithium Batteries (MSP-C, MSP-VD, LCP)

To back up data in the non volatile RAM in case of a voltage drop, the subassemblies MSG-C,
MSP-VD (MSP-V8) and LCP contain Lithium batteries. Lithium batteries have an extended life time.
The battery voltage is checked by the BIT of the system. The individual batteries are soldered to the
pc boards. The battery back up function is enabled via jumpers, set during first setup or before replacĆ
ing the respective pc board. Always observe the label on the battery. The Lithium battery has to be
replaced by the same battery type. Other types of lithium battery are not approved by Thales ATM.

WARNING

Do not recharge, disassemble, heat above 100 °C or incinerate the lithium cell. Do not
short circuit, or solder directly on the cell. Disregard of the norms regarding the use of
lithium batteries may cause risk of fire, explosion or leaking out of toxid liquid and gas.
Run-down batteries are objects that can pollute the environment and must be disposed
of with proper precautions.

CAUTION

Contents of the RAM will be lost when the jumper is opened which enables battery voltage
to the RAM device.

- Replacing Lithium battery:

We recommend switching the transmitter whose Lithium batteries are to be replaced over to
standby operation and then switching it off. The other transmitter will remain switched onto the anĆ
tenna. This will ensure that any interference resulting unintentionally from the replacement proceĆ
dure will not affect the radiated signal. A soldering iron with a grounded soldering tip should be
used. A battery short-circuit via the soldering iron for the duration of soldering is unlikely to harm
the relatively high-impedance battery, but should however be avoided wherever possible. The
procedures is as follows:

- Back up the data of the respective transmitter being serviced.


- Draw out halfway concerned pc board.
- Remove jumper (X7 on MSG-C, X7 on MSP-VD (MSP-V8), X36 on LCP).
- Re-tin the soldering tags of the new battery in order to ensure a good soldered connection
- Unsolder the minus and plus pole of the old battery, and remove the battery from the pc board.
- Insert the new battery, and solder the minus and plus pole of the battery.

NOTE: If the rack supply voltage needs to be disconnected during the period when the batteries
are unsoldered, the charge stored in the circuit capacitors will protect the RAM contents
for approx. 30 s. If the information is lost however, all transmitter parameters must be re-
entered when the batteries have been resoldered.

Ed. 01.02 5-5


CVOR 431
Maintenance Operation and Maintenance

5.3.2 Maintaining Emergency Battery


5.3.2.1 Battery Voltage
Measurement of the battery voltage is performed via the CSL and evaluated by the LCP processor.
The voltage measured is that between the BAT1 or BAT2 terminals against GND (BAT0). The half voltĆ
age value should be exactly half the full value. Should unbalance occur, a fault is indicated. The deviĆ
ation in the ratio of 2:1 for the half voltage measurement increases the further the aging process of
a cell is advanced. If the deviation from the ratio of 2:1 is minimal, the battery can be maintained in
service, but should be kept under observation. If the deviation is greater (from as little as a few tenths
of one volt), each cell must be measured under load in order to determine the weak cell. This should
be replaced by a new cell as soon as possible. The battery half to be examined may be determined
as follows.
Voltage ratio: locate faulty Cell:
greater than 2:1 (e.g. 47: 23 V = 2.043:1) between center and minus
smaller than 2:1 (e.g. 47: 24 V = 1.958:1 ) between center and plus

CAUTION

Before replacing the battery or individual cells, always check:


- Is the battery-charged power supply switched on ?
- Switch off fuse switch F1 (50 A) in battery fuse box, if the BCPS is on.

5.3.3 Matching the Charging Voltage of BCPS Modules


5.3.3.1 Reasons for Voltage Matching

The BCPS has a fixed voltage of 54 V±3 % for parallel operation with lead batteries. It is not possible
to vary the output voltage for operation with other types of battery, e.g. nickel cadmium batteries. An
adjustment of ±1 V is however possible on the front panel of the slide in units. This is intended for
optimization of the trickle charge. The most important parameter for operation of lead batteries at the
BCPS is the trickle charge voltage. This voltage is 2.23 V/cell ±1% in accordance with VDE (registered
society of german electrical engineers). In the interests of optimizing the charge Thales ATM has utiĆ
lized the upper tolerance limits and fixed the trickle charge voltage at 2.25 V/cell. This results in a trickle
charge voltage of 54 V for a battery with a rated voltage of 48 V. Strictly speaking however this fixed
trickle charge value of 54 V is only valid at a temperature of 20 °C in the battery compartment. If the
temperature rises above 20 °C, it is necessary to reduce the voltage in order to maintain a sufficient
difference with respect to the gassing voltage of 2.4 V cell. If the temperature falls below 20 °C, it is
necessary to increase the charging voltage in order to ensure optimum charging. The relationship
between the temperature and the charging voltage is shown in the table below. It is valid for the types
of battery proposed or provided by Thales ATM. Please consult the manufacturer if using other types.

BATTERY TEMPERATURE IN °C TRICKLE CHARGE VOLTAGE IN V


10 55.08
15 54.54
20 54.0
25 53.46
30 52.92

5-6 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Maintenance
The internal temperature in the battery compartment is subject to fluctuations dependent on the time
of day and time of year. The considerable mass of the batteries and the associated high thermal inertia
mean that temperature fluctuations dependent on the time of day are insignificant and can be ignored.
It is necessary on the other hand to determine the average temperature in the battery compartment
during the hot and cold seasons or to estimate it on the basis of experience. The optimum charging
voltage can be read off from the table when the average temperature has been calculated.

It is not necessary in moderate climatic zones to take seasonal fluctuations into account. If the batterĆ
ies are accommodated inside a shelter or a building, the fluctuations between summer and winter are
not very great, and the mean temperature will not deviate substantially from 20 °C. In such cases it
is not necessary to optimize the trickle charge voltage as described here. This only becomes necesĆ
sary if the batteries are installed outside the shelter or in hot or cold zones without an air-conditioned
battery compartment.

If the mean annual temperature is known during the installation phase, adjustments can be carried
out by the ANS installation team. Otherwise they should be carried out by the customer's own mainteĆ
nance personnel as follows.

5.3.3.2 Matching the Voltage

NOTE: This procedure is performed once during installation or if other battery types are used.

The battery must be connected. Switch off the transmitters. Using the switches on the front panel
switch off the ACC units except the outer left one, which has to be adjusted first. Beginning with left
ACC unit adjust the ACC units as follows:
- Connect a digital voltmeter to the test jacks on the front panel of the switched on ACC unit.
- Set the desired voltage carefully at the potentiometer on the front panel with the aid of a calibration
screwdriver. It should be possible to obtain the value specified in the table in 5.3.3.1 to within a
tolerance of ±0.2 V.
- Switch off the adjusted ACC unit.
- Switch on the next ACC unit and adjust it in the same way.
- Adjust all installed ACC units in the same way.

When all units have been set in this way measurements should be performed as follows:

- Disconnect the battery.


- Perform measurements between +BAT and -BAT on the BCPS terminal plate using a digital
voltmeter:
First measurement : Transmitter off, BCPS without load
Second measurement : Transmitter on, BCPS with load

The values should not deviate from the set value by more than ±1 %. If the deviation is greater, the
relevant module can be determined by deactivating the power units individually and observing the
voltage change. The voltage of this unit must then be corrected upwards or downwards. The BCPS
is then ready for service.

Ed. 01.02 5-7


CVOR 431
Maintenance Operation and Maintenance

5-8 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Maintenance
5.4 STARTUP, CARE AND MAINTENANCE OF THE LEAD BATTERY
5.4.1 Startup Specifications for the Lead Battery in Navigation Installations
5.4.1.1 General

For countries in Europe, the sets of lead batteries in the navigation installations are normally supplied
already filled and charged by the manufacturer. On site the batteries then merely need to be installed
and connected to the power supply unit of the navigation installation. Batteries supplied in a non-
filled state to their point of installation must be set up, filled and charged there in accordance with the
manufacturers handling specifications. The batteries can be supplied non-filled in either a dry pre-
charged state, or a non pre-charged state (see 5.4.1.3.2 and 5.4.1.3.3 ). The battery may not be
removed from its transport packing until immediately prior to startup.

CAUTION

Maintenance-free batteries have to be set into operation within half a year after delivery
to prevent drawback in the battery lifetime

The startup procedure comprises the following stages:

a) Installation on site, interconnection of the cells with the cell connectors and connection to the
electrical installation;
b) Filling with accumulator acid;
c) Immediate subsequent charging or activation of the plates (see 5.4.1.3)
d) Immediate subsequent activation in standby parallel mode.

These instructions do not cover the installation work, but instead deal merely with filling and activation
using tools which, even in remote areas, are either available or easily obtainable. They moreover apĆ
ply only to batteries for which a rated acid density of 1.24 kg/l is specified by the manufacturer, e.g.
Gro E, iron-clad and block batteries, and not to starter batteries or batteries with a fixed electrolyte.
The aids required are as follows:

Accumulator acid The acid must have a particular density. If this value is incorrect, the mixture
should be made up of high-density sulphuric acid and specially purified waĆ
ter (see 5.4.1.2.2 ).

1 Acid syringe with areometer


1 Thermometer
1 Acid jug (non-metallic)
supplied with battery
1 Funnel (non-metallic)
- Float acid level indicator
- Handling specifications

- Battery-charging power supply (BCPS), type FRAKO


- Various resistors
- Single-wire cables (2.5... 6 mm@)
- Ammeter and voltmeter (accuracy <1 %)

Ed. 01.02 5-9


CVOR 431
Maintenance Operation and Maintenance

5.4.1.2 Preliminary Operations


5.4.1.2.1 Accumulator Acid and Specially Purified Water

Diluted sulphuric acid and specially purified water are used for filling and topping up lead batteries.
The regulations specified in VDE 0510 (regulations for accumulators and battery installations), acĆ
cording to which no components which may be harmful to the plates may be used, must be conĆ
formed with. Particularly harmful substances are chlorine, which is present both in the water and in
the acid, and iron which is sometimes contained in the acid. These impurities can however easily be
evidenced. Only specially purified water, i.e. water which has been distilled or fully desalted, may be
used. It must moreover be clear, colorless and odorless

CAUTION

Boiled water, rainwater, well water, river water, tap water or condensation from machines,
heating systems etc. are unsuitable.

The sulphuric acid and the water should be kept in glass or plastic containers, which must be sealed
and covered carefully. Dust and vapors which penetrate may contaminate originally pure liquids.

5.4.1.2.2 Mixing Sulphuric Acid


If the accumulator acid does not have a specified density, specially purified water should be mixed
with a high-density acid (mixed acid) in order to obtain the values shown in the chart (Fig. 5-1).

WARNING

When mixing high-density acid with water the acid must be added to the water in a thin
stream whilst stirring with a clean wooden rod. If the water is added to the acid, the latter
will splash dangerously.

special purified water density of mixed acid (kg/l) *


Litres 0 1,200 1,250 1,300
100
1,350
10
90
20 1,400
80
30
70
40 1,500
60
quantity of mixed acid

50 1,600
50
60 1,710
40 1,800
70
A
30
80
20 90
10 100
0
values at 20 °C (68 °F) 1,180 1,220 1,260 1,300 1,340
* mixed acid: available high-density acid nominal density of accumulator acid (kg/l)

Fig. 5-1 Accumulator acid chart

5-10 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Maintenance
Example for mixing accumulator acid:

100 l accumulator acid with a density of 1.24 kg/l is required. The mixing acid available has a density
of 1.71 kg/l. The intersection A on the right-hand side of the chart (Fig. 5-1) is obtained as follows:

The slope 1.71 (density of mixed acid) intersects the vertical 1.24 (nominal density of accumulator
acid). The horizontal through point A intersects the slope at 72 l (specified purified water) and the vertiĆ
cal at 31 l (quantity of mixed acid) in the left-hand section of the chart. The two quantities must then
be mixed in order to obtain 100 l acid with a density of 1.24 kg/l. This chart is only valid for temperaĆ
tures of +20 °C. For other operating temperatures see 5.4.1.2.3

When purchasing mixed acid it may be that the quantity is specified in kilograms on the container.
The chart (Fig. 5-1) is however only valid for quantities specified in liters. Kilograms can be converted
to liters as follows:

Quantity in kg
Quantity in l =
Acid density in kg/l

5.4.1.2.3 Relationship between the Acid Density and the Temperature

The nominal acid density of fixed batteries is valid at an acid temperature of 20 °C. If the temperature
increases the density will be reduced by 0.0007 kg/l per °C; if the temperature falls it will be increased
accordingly. Thus if the temperature rises by 15 °C the density will be reduced by approx 0.01 kg/l;
if the temperature falls by 15 °C the density will be increased by approx. 0.01 kg/l. The chart (Fig. 5-2)
shows the acid densities for various temperatures in relation to a temperature of +20 °C.

measured density
kg/l

1,35 density at +20 °C


(reference temperature)
kg/l acid temperature
°C
1,30
1,30 50

40
1,25
1,25
30

1,20 1,20 20

10
1,15
1,15 0

1,10 -10
1,10
-20

Example: - measured density=1.23 kg/l


- measured acid temperature =+35 °C
The line between the two points intersects the middle scale at 1.24 kg/l
(density at reference temperature of +20 °C).

Fig. 5-2 Chart showing the relationship between the acid density and the temperature

Ed. 01.02 5-11


CVOR 431
Maintenance Operation and Maintenance

5.4.1.2.4 Basic Rules for Handling Batteries


A few basic rules listed below should be observed when handling batteries:

WARNING

It is forbidden to use naked flames or incandescent bodies in the vicinity of accumulators.


This is particularly dangerous during the charging procedure, since oxyhydrogen gas is
produced when the gassing level of the accumulator acid.

Caution should be observed when opening the inspection plugs. On no account should
salt crystals or other foreign bodies be allowed to get into the acid is reached.

Caution should be observed when topping up with specially purified water and when meaĆ
suring the acid density. Remove splashes of liquid, or conductive layers might form, allowĆ
ing creepage. Seal the inspection plugs again.

Maintenance-free batteries need not to be refilled. No acid density check is necessary.

Caution should be observed when mixing high-density acid with water. The acid should
be added to the water in a thin stream whilst stirring with a clean wooden rod. If water is
added to the acid, the latter will splash dangerously.

Splashes of acid should be neutralized and salts removed using a lukewarm soda soluĆ
tion (100 g soda to 1 l water).

Care should be taken to ensure that no soda solution gets into the cells. After treating with
the soda solution, clean with clear water and wipe dry.

Sufficient ventilation should be provided for the battery compartment. The acid vapors are
aggressive; be careful of clothing.

Specially marked and stored test leads should be used for battery measurements on acĆ
count of the acid residues which may be present.
The following points should be observed in order to prevent false acid density measurements with
the areometer:

a) The areometer float should not stick to the side or hit the top, and should always be clean.

b) When the battery is charged or discharged a period of about 30 minutes should be waited
before commencing measurements in order to allow time for the acid density between and
above the plates to become uniform.

c) If specially purified water is used for topping up, no measurements should be performed for
the next few hours.

d) If the temperature should deviate substantially from the reference temperature of +20 °C, this
should be taken into consideration when performing measurements (the density decreases with
higher temperatures and increases with lower temperatures).

5-12 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Maintenance
5.4.1.2.5 Filling the Batteries with Acid

A particular quantity of accumulator acid is required for each battery type. This quantity is specified
by the manufacturer or is defined by the cell levels (acid level indicator or max. marking on the cell
box). The tolerance of the accumulator acid density is ±0.01 kg/l.The acid temperature should not
exceed +35 °C, since heat is developed internally following filling, and higher acid temperatures may
cause the maximum permitted battery temperature to be exceeded.

In hot climates with the associated high ambient temperatures it is particularly difficult to cool down
the batteries during the day. We therefore recommend slowly filling the batteries half full in such reĆ
gions, then filling them right up the next day after they have cooled down during the night.

NOTE: The battery should not be removed from its transport packaging until immediately prior
to startup (see also Section 5.4.1.1).

5.4.1.3 Startup

Initial charging or activation.

5.4.1.3.1 General

The initial charging fully activates the plates, and for this special rules and data apply which deviate
from the standard values for battery operation and charging procedures. If the initial charging proceĆ
dure is not performed in accordance with the specifications, the plates will only be partly activated;
coarse sulphates will be produced, and the batteries will not reach their full capacity. Such damage
can only sometimes be eliminated by means of a time-consuming desulphating procedure.

As mentioned above in 5.4.1.1, the batteries may be supplied non-filled in either a dry pre-charged
state, or a non pre-charged state. This is not apparent externally except from the color of the plates.
The positive plate of activated batteries has a brown coloring (Pb O2), whilst the negative plate is light
grey (Pb).

5.4.1.3.2 Dry Pre-charged Batteries

Dry pre-charged batteries are activated by the manufacturer. They can be started up simply by filling
the battery with accumulator acid of the specified acid density. The battery can then be operated in
the navigation installation without any further delay. This however applies only to brand new batteries,
since these batteries are extremely sensitive to climatic conditions.If dry pre-charged batteries are
stored for some time without being filled with acid, the plates will gradually become deactivated. This
process is accelerated in a moist or warm environment.They will be completely deactivated after
about 6 months, and the battery must be treated and started up in almost the same way as a non-actiĆ
vated battery. The initial charging procedure will take more or less time depending on the storage periĆ
od and the state of the plates.

5.4.1.3.3 Non Pre-charged Batteries

These batteries have the longest initial charging period. They can be recognized by the fact that the
acid density drops substantially 1 to 2 hours after filling (density <1.15 kg/l), and/or the acid temperaĆ
ture rises by a few degrees.

Ed. 01.02 5-13


CVOR 431
Maintenance Operation and Maintenance

5.4.1.3.4 Initial Charging

WARNING

There is a particular risk during the charging procedure, since oxyhydrogen gas develops
in the gassing level of the battery acid is reached. It is therefore forbidden to use naked
flames or incandescent bodies in the vicinity of accumulators. Sufficient ventilation should
be provided for the battery compartment. The acid vapors are aggressive, therefore care
should be taken of clothing.
The battery manufacturers specify various methods with settings and nominal data. The appropriate
instructions are contained in the handling specifications accompanying with each battery. A constant
current charge (I-characteristic) is used for the battery charged power supply in the navigation instalĆ
lation. Two test shunts, which generate a voltage drop of 2 mV/A, are installed in the BCPS. Current
measurements can thus be performed via the software.
The acid density and temperature must be measured and noted once an hour during the charging
procedure at every 6th or 3rd cell (test cells). The same applies to the battery voltage, which should
be measured at the battery poles. For voltage measurements see Chapter 5.4.1.1 ).The duration of
the charging procedure depends on the state of the plates, and should be at least 6 hours.The crucial
factor for determining the end of the charging procedure is that the battery voltage and the acid densiĆ
ty no longer rise over a test interval of 2 hours, and that the nominal values have been reached.If the
acid density and the battery voltage do not reach their nominalvalues despite absolute conformance
with the charging specifications, the charging procedure must be continued with the same charging
data for a further 10 hours. If the acid density still does not reach its nominal value, the acid density
must be adjusted. If the density is too low, higher-density acid (mixed acid) must be added. If the
acid density is too high, specially purified water must be used for topping up. The temperature and
acid level must be taken into consideration when measuring the density, in other words the nominal
acid density is valid when the acid level indicator is at max.

If water is lost during the charging procedure on account of gassing, the acid must be topped up with
specially purified water. If it is necessary to correct the acid density or acid level, the battery must be
topped up beforehand with specially purified water. If it is necessary to correct the acid density or acid
level, the battery must be charged again with the same charging values for approx. 1 hour in order
to make sure the acid is properly mixed. This is ensured by means of the gassing which results.The
acid temperature must be monitored during the charging procedure. This is particularly important in
case of high ambient temperatures. The acid temperature may not exceed 55 °C. If a temperature
of 50 °C is reached, a cooling period should be allowed until the temperature has dropped to 35 °C
again.
The battery is ready for service when the nominal values have been reached and each cell has the
correct acid level (max. marking of acid level indicator). Finally the outside of the battery should be
cleaned with water to remove acid and dirt. The battery should then be installed immediately in the
navigation installation, and operated in standby parallel mode. This procedure ensures that the batĆ
tery is always charged, but that it is not operated close to the gassing level. The charge characteristic
of the BCPS (current/voltage characteristic or I-U characteristic) ensures that the limit values speciĆ
fied by the battery manufacturer are conformed with, including subsequently charging and dischargĆ
ing operation. No further measures are necessary.
NOTE: Each battery cell/battery must have the same charge or discharge state on account of the
series connection.
The following table summarizes the procedure.

5-14 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Maintenance

No. Procedure Duration in hrs Remarks


1 Filling with acid - See 5.4.1.2 (Preliminary Operations). Unscrew
inspection plugs, but leave over the hole in order
to prevent contamination whilst allowing gas to
escape.
2 Interval 2
3 Density measurements - The density provides information on the state of
plates. Densities less than 1.15 kg/l mean that
the battery has been stored for a long time or is
not pre-charged. A higher charging current can
be used in such cases.
4 Charging as per data, see 6 ... 55 The acid density and battery voltage should be
also WARNING in section measured every 1 or 2 hours. Note the values
5.4.1.3.4 . and compare with previous measurements and
nominal values. When the nominal values are
reached, stop charging and continue at No. 5 in
this table.
5 Interval 1
6 Acid level correction - With purified water.
7 Charging with data as No. 4 2 Repeat Nos. 7 to 9 until the acid density and batĆ
in this table tery voltage cease to change when the previous
measurements, and the nominal values are
reached.
8 Interval 1
9 Acid density and battery -
voltage measurements
10 Set acid density and acid - If corrections are necessary, recommence at No.
level to nominal values. 7.
Screw on
inspection plugs.
11 Clean battery with water - See 5.4.1.2.4 (basic rules for handling batterĆ
(external surfaces) and ies).
grease poles.
12 Operate battery in standby -
parallel mode.

5.4.2 Care and Maintenance of the Lead Battery


5.4.2.1 Maintenance Accessories and Scope of Checks
The accessories below are required for monitoring and maintenance of the battery.
1 Acid syringe with areometer
1 Acid jug
1 Funnel non-metal
1 Container with specially purified water
Various cleaning agents (acid-resistant Vaseline, soda, cotton rags).
The maintenance chapters below refer to the scope of check to be carried out. The checks and related
operations should be performed regularly every 2 to 3 months. The Basic Rules for Handling Batteries
(see 5.4.1.2.4 ) should be observed.

Ed. 01.02 5-15


CVOR 431
Maintenance Operation and Maintenance

5.4.2.1.1 Keeping the Lead Battery Clean

The battery box with batteries, boxes, terminals and connections should be kept clean and dry. When
performing the regular check pay special attention to the poles and cell connections, since these are
particularly subject to acid aggression and susceptible to the formation of salt crystals, especially at
the plus-pole. The poles and cell connections should be greased slightly with an acid-resistant
Vaseline following cleaning.

5.4.2.1.2 Measuring the Acid Density (not for maintenance-free batteries)

The acid density should be measured using the areometer. False measurements can be avoided by
observing the rules see 5.4.1.2.4 . The density of accumulator acid is 1.24 ± 0.01 kg/l at 20 °C when
the battery is charged. If the temperature deviates substantially from the reference temperature of
20 °C, this should be taken into account when measurements are performed.

5.4.2.1.3 Topping Up the Cells (not for maintenance-free batteries)

The cells should be topped up in good time with specially purified water. A visual check of the cells
should be done approx. every 2 to 3 month. An acid level indicator with two markings 10 mm apart
is incorporated in one of the cells for determining the nominal acid level. If this indicator is missing,
the cells should be topped up to 15 mm above the top of the plates. It is not always possible to obtain
specially purified or desalinated water of the required quality at the point of installation. In countries
where the water quality is inadequate the specially purified or fully desalinated water in stock should
be checked before use in accordance with the handling specifications of the battery manufacturer
(test chemicals supplied if required). If the purified water does not meet the specifications, it must be
post-treated (ion exchanger or distilling apparatus - supplied on request) or suitable water must
be obtained.

CAUTION

The battery guarantee is only valid if the accumulator acid and water have the necessary
degree of purity.

5.4.2.1.4 Measuring the Cell Voltage

The nominal voltage of the lead cells has been fixed at 2.0 V. The no-load voltage is 2.04 to 2.1 V
depending on the acid density. The discharge voltage is dependent on the discharge current. The
higher the discharge current, the lower will be the cell voltage and vice versa. Under normal operating
conditions with trickle charging the cell voltage is 2.25 V.

In case of a failure or disconnection of the 230 or 115 V mains voltage resulting in discharging of the
batteries, the cell voltage will be 2.1...1.75 V after about 5 minutes up to disconnection of the PMM.
The cell voltage should not fall below 1.75 V during discharging. This is ensured by the supervision
of the (D)VOR installation. The cell voltage can be measured either as described in 5.4.1.1 or using
a multimeter. Only special test leads provided exclusively for battery measurements should be used,
however, due to the acid residues which may be present at the battery poles. It is sufficient to check
the voltage of all cells under charging current every 2 to 3 months.

5-16 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Fault Location

CHAPTER 6
FAULT LOCATION AND REPAIR
6.1 FAULT LOCATION
6.1.1 General
Fault location in the CVOR System can be executed with the PC and ADRACS (see Section 6.1.2)
or with the fault location support procedure in Section 6.1.3. You should print out all settings, BITE
values and monitor values of the transmitter, the monitor and LCP on the finally set system that has
reached operating temperature. This data consists of the reference values, a knowledge of which will
substantially facilitate troubleshooting. These values are assumed for the following troubleshooting
procedure. If HF modules are replaced, the printout should be updated because HF modules have
greater tolerances. This log of the ACTUAL state is a basis for the troubleshooting procedure.
NOTE: Both SB1, SB2 and SBA, SBB are used as term for sideband signals in CVOR/DVOR sysĆ
tems. SBA, SBB are used normally for CVOR (signals to dipole A or B), the terms SB1,
SB2 are generally used in other Navaids 400 systems.
6.1.2 Fault Evaluation with PC and WIN ADRACS
Any fault is stored in the system memory, which occurs in the installation and is acknowledged by
the internal BIT and which leads to a WARNING or ALARM indication. Fault location in Navaids 400
can be performed by use of the BIT report in the ADRACS program. This report is available in the conĆ
figuration menu of the ADRACS program:
- Move mouse cursor to field TRANSMITTER or MONITOR or LCP, a cursor more appears.
- Click twice for more information about transmitter or monitor or LCP. The ensuing BIT results are
displayed and can be interpreted or printed out.
6.1.3 Fault Location Support CVOR (50 W and 100 W)
In addition to the BIT fault report ( see 6.1.2), the following fault location tables list typical faults, which
may occur in a CVOR installation. The tables contain 5 columns: Step, Fault, A to C. To execute fault
location in the following tables, start with left column and proceed to the right following A, B or C, and
then from next row in A to C, if necessary.
6.1.3.1 Power Supply and Module Indicators
The BIT fault report (see 6.1.2) indicates faulty operating voltages, so that the defective module
(AC/DC converter or DC/DC converter) can be defined and replaced. Before replacing the AC/DC
converters, check mains power supply. Before locating a fault, try to define roughly the defective funcĆ
tional group, i.e. power supply, transmitter, antenna, monitor or LCP. A first localization is done by evalĆ
uating the LED indicators on the various modules (see Figs. 3-15, 3-16):
Step Fault A B C
1 ACC LED out? ACC switched to ON? Check power supply to
ACC or change ACC
2 DCC LED out? ACC switched to ON? Check power supply to
TX1/TX2 at PMM switched on? DCC or change DCC
3 LCP Live-lamp out? DC operating voltage ok? Reset LCP
4 MSP-VD Live-lamp out? DC operating voltage ok? Resetprocessor
5 MSG-C Live-lamp out? DC operating voltage ok? Resetprocessor
6 CSL MON1 LED lit? Monitor 1 faulty Check according to followĆ
MON2 LED lit? Monitor 2 faulty ing tables 6.1.3.2 ff.
TX1 ON LED out? TX1 power supply on?
TX2 ON LED out? TX2 power supply on?

Ed. 01.02 6-1


CVOR 431
Fault Location Operation and Maintenance

6.1.3.2 Localization of the defective Equipment Part (1)


Step Fault A B C
1.1 Bothmonitors Feed the transmitting antenna If the fault disappears, search
show the same from the other transmitter. for it in the transmitter
fault.
Are both monitors fed from Is the transmitter correctly set? If yes, check the dipole
the same dipole via one line? and the line
1.2 The affiliation to The transmitting antenna or Check the levels of the returnĆ
the transmitter the HF lines to the antenna ing HF signals:
or monitor is are defective. Antenna or cable defective
still unclear. TX1/2 BITE ADC-1: for:

ACA1R too high Carrier

ASB1R too high SBA (SB1)

ASB2R too high SBB (SB2)

Are the return signals in order This is an indication of a


when the transmitter is running fault in the antenna syĆ
on dummy load? stem.

If no success, search directly


via the displayed monitor fault.
1.3 Only one moniĆ Continue searching for a
tor shows a monitor fault as from 8.1.
fault.

6.1.3.3 Status Check of the Microprocessor of the MSG-C (2)


Step Fault A B C
2.1 Status check The bottom LED on the The processor is running, ok.
by LEDs. MSG-C lights up continuĆ
ously. This is the Live lamp.

The bottom LED on the The processor has stopped. Attempt a reset; if the proĆ
MSG-C is off or lights up with Every interruption is an indicaĆ cessor stops again, the
briefinterruptions. tion of a processor fault. MSG-C is defective. Do
not repeat this; the procesĆ
sor must start up itself and
must not stop.
The second LED from the top The LCP polls the transmitter, 1) Replace the MSG-C
on the MSG-C lights up at ok.
brief intervals. 2) Check the 64-pole flat
ribbon cables from BP-C,
The second LED from the top The LCP does not poll the connector X82, to LCP,
on the MSG-C stays permaĆ transmitter, or the transmitter is and connector X71/TX1
nently off. not receiving the data. (X72/TX2) to BP-T, conĆ
nector X70.

3) Otherwise, replace the


LCP
The top LED on the MSG-C The transmitter is not sending 1) The MSG-C is defecĆ
lights up at brief intervals. any data to the LCP tive, and must be replaced

The top LED on the MSG-C The transmitter is not respondĆ 2) Check the 64-pole ribĆ
stays permanently off. ing to the polling calls of the bon cable from BP-C
LCP. (X71/TX1 or X72/TX2), to
BP-T, connector X70.

6-2 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Fault Location
6.1.3.4 RF-Level too low or missing (3)

* 100 W version only

Step Fault A B C
3.1 One monitor Fault in the monitor dipole Fault in the HF cable from Search for the fault in the
good, one moĆ monitor dipole to transmitter bad monitor and continue
nitor bad with 8.1.
3.2 Bothmonitors Search for the fault in the line
show the same from monitor dipole to transĆ
fault. mitter or in the transmitter.
3.2.1 Antenna or Measure the leading HF sigĆ TX1/2 BITE ADC-1: ACA1 If the rated value is good,
cable defective. nal at the transmitter output. examine the monitor. If the
signal is too low, search
Check the returning signal at TX1/2 BITE ADC-1: ACA1R for the fault in the transmitĆ
the transmitter output. normal? Otherwise, check the ter.
impedance of the transmitter's
termination.
3.2.2 Transmitter inĆ CSB power correctly set? TX1/2-Adjustm. CSB-Power? The nominal value should
correctlyset. be set here.
3.2.3 Transmitter RF CSB power switched off via TX1/2 BITE Digital: CSB-Power State must
power off? the control bit? CSB-Power State? be ON.
3.2.4 Supply voltage One or several supply voltĆ MON1/2 BITE Measurement: Nominal voltage ±5 %; in
for HF section? ages considerably below the DCC-MV TX1/2 (+28 V) the event of a fault, reĆ
minimum? supplies the modulators. place the power supply,
DCC-MV or DCC-28*.
TX1/2-BITE ADC-2: V281
(+28 V) supplies CA-100* .
3.2.5.1 Synthesizer Synthesizer operating outside MON1/2 Measurement:
of the frequency range from Carrier Frequency?
108 to 118 MHz Both monitors show a freĆ Replace the synthesizer.
quency error.
Only one monitor shows a freĆ Replace corr. MSP-VD or
quency error. check cable; see 8.6, 8.7.
3.2.5.2 Synthesizer Synthesizer HF output level TX1/2 BITE Digital: Replace the synthesizer.
too low. Synth. Level CSB-Signal?
3.2.6 Switched off because the conĆ TX1/2 BITE Digital: If yes, continue with
trol loop has a discontinuity. Loop Modulator CSB-1? 3.2.6.1.
3.2.6.1 Control loop of First set CSB=0 W. RF-Level >50 %:
the transmitter Then set CSB=5 W or less. control loop open, thin HF - Check cable
has a discontiĆ cable has come off CA-100,
nuity. or has been pressed out of - Check cable
CCP-V,
Directional coupler in the - Replace CA-100*
CA-100* defective or has a
discontinuity,
MOD 110 for CSB is defective - Replace MOD-110
or CCP-V defective for CSB
- Replace CCP-V
3.2.6.2 Check ampliĆ First set CSB=0 W, 30 % < RF-Level <40 % Modulation depth at nomiĆ
tude control Then set CSB=0.1 Pnom. Control loop is good. nal power is reduced
loop. CA-100 only operating with Replace CA-100*.
partial power.
3.2.7 Control signal from the TX1/2 BITE ADC2: Substantially less than the
MSG-S is too low. Set the CSB_1S2, CSB_1_ST_6 at the nominal value.
transmitter's nominal power. nominal value? Replace the MSG-S

Ed. 01.02 6-3


CVOR 431
Fault Location Operation and Maintenance

6.1.3.5 Modulation Depth of the Carrier is too low (4)


Applicability: VOR: 9960 Hz auxiliary carrier, identity and voice, not for 30 Hz AM composed of carrier and sideband.
DVOR: 30 Hz AM, identity and voice, not for the 9960 auxiliary carrier, which is composed of carrier and
sideband. * 100 W version only

Step Fault A B C
4.1 One monitor Search for the fault in the bad Condition: neither monitor may
good, one monitor and continue with 8.1. have more than 110 % RF
monitor bad level; otherwise, measuring erĆ
rors may occur.
4.2 Bothmonitors Search for the fault in the Condition: neither monitor may
show the same transmitter. have more than 110 % RF
fault. level; otherwise, measuring erĆ
rors may occur.

TX1/2 BITE ADC-1: Check the impedance of


ACA1R normal? the transmitter's terminaĆ
tion if ACA1R is substanĆ
tially higher.
4.2.1 Adjustment erĆ Modulation depth correctly - Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM Correctly set modulation
ror set? - Mod. Depth Voice AM depths.
- Mod. Depth Identity AM
4.2.2 Limiting in the CA-100* goes into limiting TX1/2 BITE ADC-1:
HF power secĆ too early. ACM1 higher than normal? Replace CA-100*
tion
Halve the set power "Carrier
Power":
- Mod. depth is increased: CA-100* defective
- Mod. depth remains: Other fault
4.2.3 Carrier modulator MOD-110 TX1/2 BITE ADC-1:
goes into limiting. ACM1 normal or lower? Replace MOD-110 (CSB)

Halve the set power "Carrier


Power":
- Mod. depth is increased: MOD-110 (CSB) faulty
- Mod. depth remains: Other fault
4.3 Controlsignals Control signal from the CSB_1_S2 normal? If no, replace MSG-S.
MSG-S is not correct. CSB_1_ST6 normal?
4.3.1 30 Hz FM index is wrong, too Is Mod. Index 30 Hz FM corĆ Replace MSG-C; if necĆ
low or 0. rectly set? essary, replace also
The FM is generated on the MSG-S.
MSG-C together with the
MSG-S.
4.3.2 The modulation depth of the TransmitterCommands: Identity must be "ON".
identity is wrong or is missing. - Is "Identity OFF"?
- Is Mod. Depth Identity AM
setcorrectly?
Set output power to 0.5 Pnom:

- Is the identity then OK? If yes, CA-100 or


To recheck this, you may MOD-110 (CSB) are
need to set Ident CW- overdriven; see 4.2.2 and
Mode 4.2.3.

6-4 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Fault Location
Step Fault (4 cont.) A B C
4.3.3 The modulation depth of the Re-check under 'TX1/2 BITE If these signals are not
identity is wrong and, indeĆ ADC-2': good, replace MSG-S or
pendently of the transmitted ID_ST_2 and ID_ST_5 MSG-C.
power, the control signal is
wrong.
4.3.4 Ident Morse code is not workĆ Is the code correctly set? Replace MSG-C
ing or is defective. The Morse code is generated
completely on the MSG-C.

6.1.3.6 Modulation by Sidebands too low or wrong (5)


Thisdescriptionconcernssignalsthatarecomposedofcarrier(CSB) and sideband signals (SBO). Here, not only the right level
conditionsof CSB and SBO must be ensured, but also the right phase. Errors of the sidebands almost always lead to azimuth
errors. Both error types must be considered in relation to one another.
Step Fault A B C
5.1 One monitor Search for the fault in the bad Condition: neither monitor may
good, one monitor and continue with 8.1. have more than 110 % RF
monitor bad level; otherwise, measuring erĆ
rors may occur.
5.2 Bothmonitors Search for the fault in the Condition: neither monitor may
show the same transmitter. have more than 110 % RF
fault. level; otherwise, measuring erĆ
rors may occur.

TX1/2 BITE ADC-1: Otherwise, check the imĆ


ACA1R normal? pedance at the correĆ
ASB1R and ASB2R normal? sponding transmitter terĆ
mination.
5.2.1 Amplitude TX1/2 Adjustments:
wrong Level of the sideband set corĆ - SBA Power Level
rectly? - SBB Power Level
Phase of the sideband set - SBA Phase Adjustment
correctly? - SBB Phase Adjustment
5.2.2 One or both SB modulator(s) SB power too low? If ASB1 and ASB2 deviate
is/are not producing enough Check the test output for side by less than ±5 % from
modulationdepth. band forward signal: the previously measured
TX1 BITE ADC-1: value in the same operatĆ
ASB1 and ASB2, right or too ing state, the output level
low? is good, and the fault is
presumed in the phase.
Continue with 5.2.3 ff.

Carrier level too high. Check Ensure the correct carrier


whether carrier power is corĆ level.
rectly set; forward ACA1 right
or too high?
5.2.2.1 The synthesizer does not osĆ MON1/2 Measurement: If the frequency is wrong,
cillate in the range from 108 to Carrier Frequency? replace SYN.
118 MHz.

Synthesizer output level too TX1/2 BITE Digital: Level too low, replace
low Level SB1: BFSBA0 ok? SYN.
Level SB2: BFSBA0 ok?

Ed. 01.02 6-5


CVOR 431
Fault Location Operation and Maintenance

Step Fault (5 cont.) A B C


5.2.2.2 Supply voltage: The control 28V present? Otherwise,replace
signals at the output of the MON1/2 BITE Measurement: DCC-MV.
modulators ASB1 or ASB2 are 28V DCC-MV > 26.5V?
lower than in the basic setting.
5.2.2.3 The control signals at the outĆ Compare the control signals If SB1A_ST3 and
put of the modulators ASB1 or SB1A_ST3 and SB2A_ST3 SB2A_ST3 are equal to or
ASB2 are lower than in the with the original values. more than originally, reĆ
basic setting. place the corresponding
modulator.
The fault is unlikely to be
caused by the CCP-V.

If SB1A_ST3 and SB2A_ST3 Replace MSG-S, possibly


are lower or zero, then control replace MSG-C.
by the MSG-S is defective.
5.2.3 Side band and carrier phases do not match.
5.2.3.1 Wrong carrier First check the carrier phase. TX-1 Measurement:
phase CSB RF Phase Measurement
Is the original value of ±5°
reached?

TX1/2 BITE ADC-1:


BU_MOD_C1?

TX1/2 Miscellaneous:
MOD-CSB-1 Sign Control?

Do both have the original


value?

BU_MOD_C1 should lie within


the range from +2V to +8V.

Phase adjustment of carrier is Replace:


not possible ifāBU_MOD_C1 - MOD-110 (CSB)
lies between -0.5 and +1.5 V - CCP-V
or between 9 and 27 V. - (possibly MSG-C )
5.2.3.2 Wrong SBA Check the side band phase. TX1/2 Adjustments:
phase SBA Phase Adjustm. Original value?

TX1/2 Measurement:
SBA RF Phase Measurement Do both values agree to
±5°?
TX1/2 Miscellan.:
MOD-SB1 Sign Control Original value?

TX1/2 BITE ADC-1:


BU_PH_SB1 Original value?

The value must change with In the event of a deviation,


the phase setting of SB1. replace:
- MOD-110 (SBA)
- (possibly CCP-V)
- MSG-S or MSG-C

6-6 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Fault Location
Step Fault (5 cont.) A B C
5.2.3.3 Phase of sideband A wrongly Set the level of sideband B to 0. If a module has been reĆ
set. Change the phase of SBA until placed, first set the original
Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM reaches value; only check the miniĆ
a minimum. Add or subtract mum and maximum.
90°. Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM must Change them only if reĆ
reach a maximum. quired.
Set the level of sideband B back
to normal.
5.2.3.4 Wrong SBB Check the sideband phase. TX1/2 Adjustments:
phase SBB Phase Adjustm. Original value?

TX1/2 Measurement:
SBB RF Phase Measurement Do both values agree to
±5°?
TX1/2 Miscellan.:
MOD-SB2 Sign Control Original value?

TX1/2 BITE ADC-1:


BU_PH_SB2 Original value?

The value must change with In the event of a deviation,


the phase setting of SB2. replace:
- MOD-110 (SBB)
- (possibly CCP-V)
- MSG-S or MSG-C
5.2.3.5 Phase of sideband B wrongly Set the level of sideband A to If a module has been reĆ
set. 0. Change the phase of SBB placed, first set the original
until Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM value; only check the miniĆ
reaches a minimum. Add or mum and maximum.
subtract 90°. Mod. Depth 30 Change them only if requiĆ
Hz AM must reach a maxiĆ red.
mum.
Set the level of sideband A
back to normal.
CAUTION: If the side band phase is offset from the right value by 180°, a perfect maximum
is the result, but the azimuth angle rotates in the wrong direction. The original angle values
must be restored before final commissioning.

6.1.3.7 Wrong Carrier Frequency (6)


Step Fault A B C
6.1 One monitor Search for the fault in the bad
good, one monitor and continue with 8.1.
monitor bad
6.2 Bothmonitors Is the right frequency enĆ TX1/2 Adjustments: Replace the synthesizer if
show wrong tered? Transmitter Frequency? the set and measured freĆ
frequency vaĆ quencies deviate from one
lues. another by more than
1.2 kHz.

Ed. 01.02 6-7


CVOR 431
Fault Location Operation and Maintenance

6.1.3.8 Azimuth Indication (7)


Step Fault A B C
7.1 One monitor Search for the fault in the bad
good, one monitor and continue with 8.1.
monitor bad
7.2 Bothmonitors Check the following values on TX1/2 Adjustments:
show wrong vaĆ both monitors: AzimutAlignment correctly set?
lues.
MON-1/2Measurement:
- Mod. Depth 9960 Hz AM 30 ±2 % ?
- Mod. Index 30 Hz FM 16 ±2 % ?
- Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM 30 ±2 % ?
7.2.3 Measure the azimuth values The measured azimuth angle One sideband is missing
as a function of the geographĆ does not change continuously or has a phase offset by
ical angle. Feed one monitor with the position of the monitor 90°.
input with the signal of the dipole, but has only two values
roof edge portable monitor diĆ that differ by 180°.
pole and record the azimuth
values and 30 Hz AM in 45° The displayed azimuth values One sideband is too small
increments. does not change continuously or has a wrong phase.
with the geographical meaĆ
sured angle.
Has Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM
Maxima and Minima?
7.2.3.1 Locate the deĆ Check settings and measured Check on the activated sideĆ
fective sideĆ values. band:
band.
TX1/2 Adjustments: Deviation from the setĆ
SBA/SBB Power Level tings?
If yes, continue with 5.2.1

TX1/2 Measurement: Deviation from the setĆ


SBA/SBB Amplitude MeasuĆ tings?
rem. If yes, continue with 5.2.3.

TX1/2 Adjustments: Deviation from the setĆ


SBA/SBB Phase Adjustment tings?
If yes, continue with 5.2.3.

TX1/2 Measurement: Deviation from the setĆ


SBA/SBB RF-Phase MeasuĆ tings?
rem. If yes, continue with 5.2.3.
7.2.3.2 Is the direction of rotation of When you walk around the Search for the position of
the azimuth correct? system in clockwise direction, the greatest azimuth error.
the azimuth angle must inĆ Only set the sideband
crease: level to "0" that does not
Wrong direction of rotation? influence Mod. Depth 30
Hz AM or only has a slight
Mod. Depth 30 Hz AM influence on it. Change the
constant over the azimuth? phase of the remaining
sideband by 180°.

6-8 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Fault Location
6.1.3.9 Fault in the Monitor (8)

The fault is presumed in the monitor. As both monitors are independent of one another, only one monitor will show the fault.

Step Fault A B C
8.1 Status check The third LED from above on The processor is running, ok
by LEDs the MSP-VD lights up continĆ
uously. This is the Live lamp.

The third LED from above on The processor has stopped. Attempt a reset; if the proĆ
the MSP-VD is off or lights Every interruption is an indicaĆ cessor stops again, the
up with brief interruptions. tion of a processor fault. MSP-VD is faulty, replace.
The second LED from the top The LCP polls the monitor, ok.
on the MSP-VD lights up at
brief intervals.
The LCP does not poll the
The second LED from the top monitor, or the monitor is not 1) Replace MSP-VD
on the MSP-VD stays permaĆ receiving the data. 2) Replace LCP
nently off.
The top LED on the MSP-VD The monitor sends data to the
lights up at brief intervals. LCP, ok

The top LED on the MSP-VD


stays permanently off. The monitor is not responding The MSP-VD is defective;
to the polling calls of the LCP. replace it.
The bottom LED indicates the The LED is bright when the
identity tone. 1020 Hz identifier tone is presĆ
See: 4.3.2 to 4.3.4. ent.
8.2 Check with the The test generator on the CSL MON-1/2Measurement: The MSP-VD module
testgenerator generates normal navigation contains the complete sigĆ
signals in 45° increments of - TSG RF-Level nal processing and evaluĆ
the azimuth, as well as one - TSG Azimuth ation circuitry.
without 30 Hz modulation and - TSG Mod.Depth 30Hz AM
one without 9960 Hz auxiliary - TSG Mod.Depth 9960Hz AM
carrier. With the hexadeciĆ - TSG Mod. Index 30Hz FM
mally coded switch on the
CSL, the corresponding chanĆ The MSP-VD is defective if In the event of a fault, reĆ
nel is set and is fed into the one or several of these signals place the MSP-VD.
monitor instead of the demoĆ show(s) the same fault as in Calibrate the new one.
dulated HF signal. the case of the transmitter. BeĆ
fore replacing the MSP-VD,
check the calibration of the inĆ
correctly displayed value.
8.3 Checking the All TSG signals are displayed The branches: band filter, HF
HF branch of correctly, but the monitor amplifier, AGC setting and deĆ
the MSP-VD shows incorrect signals of the modulator are not used by the
transmitter. TSG signals. These faults canĆ
not be detected via the TSG.

Change the AGC value until If 100 % cannot be set, or


the RF level is at 100±5 %. only in the event of a conĆ
siderably deviating AGC,
the HF branch of the MSP
is defective; replace and
readjust the MSP-VD.
8.4 Both MSP-VD The modules have been damĆ Replace both MSP-VD.
show the same aged, e.g. by a lightning strike.
value after 8.2.

Ed. 01.02 6-9


CVOR 431
Fault Location Operation and Maintenance

Step Fault (8 cont.) A B C


8.5 The identity is Is the second monitor working One monitor is good.
not displayed. properly?

If the modulation depth of the The second monitor does not The corresponding MSP is
identifier is greater than 4%, detect the identity. defective and must be reĆ
the bottom green LED must placed.
indicate the identity tone.
8.6 One monitor The monitor measures the freĆ MSP-VD defective Replace MSP-VD.
shows a wrong quency of both transmitters
carrier frequenĆ wrongly or shows 0 kHz.
cy.
Both monitors measure the Wrong frequency, but f  0 Synthesizerdefective
frequency of one transmitter
correctly, but measure the freĆ Frequency 0 kHz or 0.1 kHz. Synthesizer defective or
quency of the other wrongly. 64-pole flat ribbon cable
from BP-C, connector
X71/TX1 (X72/TX2) to
BP-T, connector X70, deĆ
fective or has come loose.

6-10 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Fault Location
6.1.3.10 Fault of the Local Control Panel (LCP) (9)

The LCP is the focal point for communication which interfaces the local PC and the Remote Control to the transmitters and
monitors. The LCP evaluates directly the battery and the mains monitoring. The LCP consists of two boards: LC-CPU, LCI.

Step Fault A B C
9.1 Live lamp off LCP board: live lamp on LC- Standstill of LCP-processor Measure at back panel
CPU off. Liquid crystal display or/and possibly no power supĆ BP-C the '5VK' voltage
screen is dark. Keys do not ply. against GND:
function.

ALARM and NORMAL remain Reset Processor of LC-CPU If 5VK is  4,9 V change
lit, LCD screen is dark. board. ALARM and NORMAL DCC-3-05.
indicatorslightsimultaneously,
until processor is initializing If 5VK is  4,9 V, check
and extinguish after that. 14-pole flat ribbon cable
from CSL front (connector
Execute lamp test: Press siĆ X4) to LCP ( connector
multaneously keys XMTR and CT5).
MON at front panel. Indicators
must light, the buzzer gives a If lamp test is not successĆ
short tone. For this test the ful though the 5VK voltage
processor and software must is ok, the LCP is faulty. ReĆ
run. place completely the LCP.
LCI: LCD LCP board: live lamp on Check ±15 V voltage supply If ok, replace LCI board
screen dark LC-CPU on. from CSL. with LCD display.
If check fauls again, reĆ
place CSL.
9.2 Live lamp on Transmitter rack, LCP: The At least one *.sit file is missing
display in MAIN STATUS field or damaged in the LCP.
indicates WARNING.
The RAM-check states a fault.
Call Menu REU OPERATIONS
in ADRACS:
⇒Control,
⇒File Transfer,
⇒Show RAM Directory All files available?
If necessary, restore the
floppy backup of the *.sit
files.
9.3 Live lamp on Transmitter rack, LCP: The The *.sit files are ok.
LCD screen shows "Actual
Installation CVOR 431".
"Maintenance Alert Warning" e.g. the battery at the LCP is Backup data. Replace the
in the LCD screen is indiĆ weak, UBat < 3.2 V . Lithium battery at the LCP.
cated. Call Menu "MainteĆ
nance Data" for more informaĆ
tion.
9.4 No commuĆ The LCP is ok. Indications Interface cable between PC Check cable? Are the origĆ
nication beĆ and controls directly at the and LCP is defective or conĆ inal cable used:
tween PC and LCP are operating, but operaĆ tacts are contaminated. Connector 9-pole, 0-MoĆ
LCP. tion via PC is not possible. dem cable?

Configuration of PC is not ok: Check serial interface port


- Is the correct port used at at PC?
the PC?
- Is any other program Checkprograms.
running at this port?
- ADRACS is missing or Re-load ADRACS if necĆ
damaged? essary.

Ed. 01.02 6-11


CVOR 431
Fault Location Operation and Maintenance

Step Fault (9 cont.) A B C


9.5 No interrogaĆ RXDA LED (second from Transmitter and monitor are The LCP interrogates only
tions to monitor above) at the MSP-VD or switched on? processors which are
or transmitter. MSG-C does not sparkle switched on.
regularly (This LED indicates
received interrogations from Check, if 64-pole flat ribbon Replace or fix cables.
LCP to monitor or transmitter). cables from BP-C, connector
X82 to LCP and from BP-C,
connectorX71/TX1(X72/TX2)
to BP-T, connector X70, are
defective or have come loose.
9.5 Both MSP-VD and both The LCP is presumably defecĆ Replace the LCP compleĆ
cont. MSG-C are not interrogated. tive. tely.

At least one MSP-VD and The fault can be located possiĆ Replace first MSP-VD or
MSG-C communicates with bly in the LCP or in the transĆ MSG-C, than LCP (or
the LCP. mitter or monitor subassemĆ LC-CPU) if replacement
blies (MSP or MSG-C) of MSG-C/MSP-VD was
notsuccessful.

6-12 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs
6.2 REPAIRS
6.2.1 General
The repair activities are designed to restore the ready condition of a faulty system in the shortest
possible time. The system is repaired by replacing the defective subassembly. The defective subasĆ
semblies can then be sent to the manufacturer for repair.
NOTE: Subassemblies and components which are sent to the manufacturer for repair or returns
must be packed in a way that no damage of the parts could arise. It is recommended to
use the original packing, e.g. of the spare part, or a comparable packing in corresponding
performance to ensure a safe shipping of defective subassemblies or components.
Handling of subassemblies with electrostatically sensitive components see section
6.2.1.1.3 .
6.2.1.1 Safety Precautions
6.2.1.1.1 General Regulations
The safety regulations laid down by the local authorities (e.g. concerning accident prevention, work
safety or operation of electronic equipment and navigation systems) must be observed at all times.
The purpose of safety precautions is to protect persons and property, and they must always be heedĆ
ed. See also Part 1, Section 1.4.
Work should not be carried out outside the shelter or on the antenna system during a storm, due to
the danger of injury by lightning.
Station shutdown due to repair and maintenance: The responsible authorities must be notified of any
work which may require operation of the system to be interrupted, in accordance with national regulaĆ
tions.
6.2.1.1.2 Work on the Equipment

WARNING

In order to avoid risks to persons and consequential damage to subassemblies, the releĆ
vant transmitter must be switched off. The battery-charged power supply (BCPS) must
always be disconnected from the mains before any work, other than measuring the voltĆ
age is carried out on it. RF cables must not be bent to a radius of less than 50 mm.
Use switch TX1 or TX2 prior to removing or inserting a subassembly or prior to removing a plug-in
connector during the course of repair and maintenance activities (see Section 6.2.3.1 for exceptions).
Switches TX1 and TX2 deactivate the DC converters for the transmitter 1 and transmitter 2 subassemĆ
blies respectively. The subassemblies which are common to both transmitters are exceptions: they
cannot be switched on and off with either TX1 or TX2. Switch NAV deactivates the complete equipĆ
ment.
6.2.1.1.3 Handling Electrostatically Sensitive Subassemblies
The ILS and (D)VOR installations contain subassemblies (plug-in cards) equipped with components
which are sensitive to electrostatic discharge. When replacing subassemblies and plug-in cards
containing electrostatically sensitive components, special precautionary measures should be taken
during removal, transport and installation in order to prevent damage to the components. We refer
to the customer documentation of the manufacturer.

Subassemblies which contain electrostatically sensitive components are


marked with this symbol.

Ed. 01.02 6-13


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance
If any of the maintenance personnel need to touch one of these subassemblies, they should place
both hands flat on a grounded conductive surface for a few seconds to eliminate static charges. The
subassembly can be touched - preferably at an insulator (board edge, lever mechanism, etc.) - as
soon as the potential has been equalized in this manner. It is advisable to avoid touching the contacts
of the plug-in connectors, the conductor paths and the components themselves. Some of the subasĆ
semblies must be left in their antistatic packaging or plastic bags as long as possible. The special
procedures described below should be followed when subassemblies and plug-in boards are
replaced within the framework of repair and maintenance activities, due to the risk of damage to elecĆ
trostatically sensitive components.

To remove a subassembly:
- Switch off the system before beginning the replacement procedure.
- Eliminate any static body charges by touching the frame of the grounded system (rack) with both
hands.
- Remove the subassembly and lay it down on a bench with a grounded conductive worktop.
- Pack the subassembly in an antistatic plastic bag and send it off to the manufacturer for repair.
To install a subassembly:
- Eliminate any static body charges by touching the frame of the grounded system (rack) with both
hands.
- Remove the subassembly from the antistatic plastic bag.
- Install the subassembly.
- Switch on the system again.

6.2.1.1.4 Components Containing Beryllium Oxide Ceramics

Some of the subassemblies are equipped with transistors containing beryllium oxide. These transisĆ
tors are in line with the latest state of the art and are in use all over the world. They are absolutely harmĆ
less in a sealed, compact condition. Beryllium oxide dust, which is detrimental to health, may however
be produced if the transistors are opened. They should not be dismantled or shattered. This applies
likewise if they are scrapped or disposed of. The following subassemblies contain power transistors
with beryllium oxide:

- Modulator 110 : Transistor types BLF242, BLF 245


Modulator 110P : Transistor types BLF244, BLF 246
- CA-100C : Transistor type BLF248

6.2.1.1.5 Handling Lead Batteries

See chapter 5, Section 5.4 ff and Part 1, Section 1.4.

6-14 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs
6.2.2 Correcting a Processor Standstill
A processor standstill may result when subassemblies are removed under voltage or on account of
static charges which are discharged from the operators to the rack. This condition is always the result
of an operator error. It is therefore advisable to pinpoint the causes as soon as it happens. There are
in fact only four possible causes, though these may occur in combination.

- Insufficient grounding of the rack


- Unsuitable and/or incorrectly cleaned floor covering
- Non-observance of clothing regulations by personnel
- Carelessness of the personnel due to inadequate information.
Any causes determined should be remedied immediately by means of appropriate measures: the
symptom will not then recur. A distinction should be made in case of a processor standstill between
a failure in the keyboard processor and a failure in the equipment central processing unit. Both the
behavior of the system and the measures to be taken are different.

6.2.2.1 Failure in the Monitor Processor


See Fig. 6-1.
The LCP shows MON1 FAULTY or MON2 FAULTY due to to the failed processor on its LCD screen.
If both monitors fail, the transmitter will be shut down.
Remedy:

- Open front door of the rack.


- CPU live lamp on the MSP must be lit.
- If live lamp is off, press reset button on MSP.
- Close door again.
- Perform login and enter password if more commands must be entered, otherwise this step may
be ignored.

The installation is then fully operational again.

6.2.2.2 Failure in the Transmitter Processor


See Fig. 6-1.
If lamps light up on the system in a manner which has no meaning and cannot be interpreted, then
go out again after a short time, then the processor has fallen out of synchronism temporarily on
account of an interference pulse, but has been able to recover. If this symptom is encountered repeatĆ
edly, the causes should be determined. If the transmitter fails on account of a processor standstill,
this is displayed by means of TX1 or TX2 WARNING on the LCP.
Remedy:

- Open front door of the rack.


- CPU live lamp on the MSG-C must be lit.
- If live lamp is off, press reset button on MSG-C.
- Close door again.
- Perform login and enter password if more commands must be entered, otherwise this step may
be ignored.

The installation is then fully operational again.

Ed. 01.02 6-15


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance

MSP

TXDA lamp
RXDA lamp
CPU live lamp , green

Modem*

Modem*

Modem*
VAM*
MSP-1

MSP-2
--
--
--
CSL

LCP
pushbutton manual reset
DCC-05

Ê
Ê ÊÊ
ÊÊ
morse code indication

Ê ÊÊ MSG-C

Ê ÊÊ
Ê
Ê ÊÊ
ÊÊ
TXDA lamp, green
RXDA lamp, green
MOD-110P
MOD-110

MOD-110

DCC-MV
MSG-C
MSG-S

Ê ÊÊ
SYN

CCP

Ê
Ê ÊÊ
ÊÊ
Ê ÊÊ
pushbutton manual reset

Ê ÊÊ
CPU live lamp , green
MOD-110P
MOD-110

MOD-110

Ê ÊÊ
DCC-MV
MSG-C
MSG-S
SYN

Ê ÊÊ
CCP

Ê ÊÊ
Ê ÊÊ
Ê
ËËË ËËË ÊÊ
PMM

Ê
ËËË ËËË ÊÊ
Ê
ËËË ËËË ÊÊ
Ê
ËËË ËËË ÊÊ
DCC-28

DCC-28

Ê
ËËË
Ê
ËËËËËËËËË
ËËË ÊÊ
ÊÊ
Ê
Ê ËËË ÊÊ
Ê ËËË
ËËË
ÊÊ
ÊÊ
Ê ËËË ÊÊ
--
ACC

ACC
ACC

Ê ËËË
Ê ËËË ÊÊ
ÊÊ
ËËË
Front

ËËË Version 100 W


* optional

Fig. 6-1 Push buttons and indications on the subassemblies MSP and MSG-C in the rack

6-16 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs
6.2.3 Replacing Subassemblies

WARNING

The heat sinks of the modulators (MOD-110P) and of the carrier amplifier (CA-100C)
may warm up during operation. This is normal and does not affect the function. When reĆ
placing these subassemblies it is recommended to let them cool down for a while or take
suitable measures (e.g. gloves). When replacing the subassemblies SYN und CCP avoid
touching the heat sinks of the MOD-110P.

6.2.3.1 Disconnecting the Voltage before Replacing Subassemblies

CAUTION

The voltage must always be disconnected before removing or installing subassemblies


(subject to only a very few exceptions). It is sufficient to switch off all the transmitter subasĆ
semblies, the DCC-MV and the DCC-28 with either of switches TX1 or TX2 on the PMM
subassembly. The transmitter subassemblies can also be switched off by means of a PC
command.
Before replacing an ACC-module the BCPS must always be disconnected from the
mains.
If a monitor subassembly is affected (MSP-VD), the associated DCC subassemblies
must be removed. It is not necessary to switch them off beforehand with both TX1 and
TX2 on the PMM.
If the CSL must be changed, both TX1 and TX2 must be switched off beforehand.
The VAM, MODEM and the DCC-3-05 subassemblies may be removed and installed
when live. The special design of their contacts prevents damage from occurring.

6.2.3.2 Subassemblies in the Transmitter Rack and Power Supply


The table below lists the work which may be necessary after a subassembly has been replaced.
Please also refer to Section 6.2.1.1.
a) The relevant transmitter must be de-energized before removing or installing subassemblies, prefĆ
erably by switching it off on the PMM subassembly. It should be noted that the following subassemĆ
blies are only de-energized if both switches and switch NAV (for CSL) on the PMM are switched
off:
LCP
DCC-3-05
CSL
MSP-VD
VAM
ASU complete (DVOR only)
b) Several of the subassemblies have DIP-FIX switches or jumpers on their pc boards. It is essential
to check that the switches or jumpers on the new subassemblies are set to the same positions as
on the old subassemblies. Section 6.2.4 contains a list of the DIP-FIX switches and jumpers.
c) Check that all the RF cables have been connected correctly before switching the transmitter on
again, and make sure that either the antenna or a dummy load is connected to the transmitter
output signals (CSB, SB1, SB2).
d) All subassemblies in the assembly carrier have plug-in RF connections.

Ed. 01.02 6-17


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance

Subassemblies of the transmitter rack

Unit to be changed Preparation Adjustments after change


SYN - Adjust station frequency

MOD-110 - check RF level, modulation depths, phasing


MOD-110P - check RF level, modulation depths, phasing
check blending modulation (DVOR)

CA-100 loosen screws, remove cables check output power

CCP - (!) readjustment of transmitter neccessary


with calibrated MSP or external measuring
equipment
RFD/Filter loosen screws, remove cables -
ASU-INT (DVOR) - -

-
MSG-S - (!) adjust or load all transmitter data
MSG-C -

- (!) calibrate monitor


MSP -
CSL - check AGC in MSP
MDS (option)

LCP complete loosen screws, remove cables re-load installation type, configuration, site
LCP, LC-CPU loosen screws, remove cables and PTT file and defined masks (*.mxn), if
necessary
LCP, LCI remove LC-CPU, loosen screws -

VAM - -
Modem LGM 28.8 - -
Modem LGM 1200MD - -

DCC-3-05 - -
DCC-28 loosen screws on front panel -
DCC-MV loosen screws on front panel -
PMM loosen screws, remove cables -

ACC-54 loosen screws on front panel -

Subassemblies of the ASU rack (DVOR only)

Unit to be changed Preparation Adjustments after change


ASC - -
ASM loosen RF cables -
BSG - (!) adjust 9960 Hz mod. depth
MOD-SBB - check blending modulation
DCC-MVD loosen screws on front panel -

Fig. 6-2 Preparation and adjustments during a subassembly replacement

6-18 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs
6.2.3.2.1 Replacing EPROM
NOTE: Before starting it is recommend to read out all parameters of the installation:
Use command Download Parameters or make a printout of all parameters or write down
manually the indicated parameters if other measures are not possible.
It is also recommended to generate a copy of the specific site files as backup:
- In the PC User Program, click the control button in the main status window.
- Select File Transfer and Copy site file to PC in the submenu. Copy all files with the
extension:*.sit, *.oio, *.msk, *.ptt.
The EPROM should always be replaced by qualified personnel only. The following subassemblies
contain EPROM which may need to be replaced: MSG-C, MSP, CSL (test generator). The locations
are shown in Section 6.2.4.

CAUTION

Since the EPROM are electrostatically sensitive components, the following safety precauĆ
tions must always be observed (see also Section 6.2.1.1.3 ): The person replacing the
EPROM should preferably not wear shoes with rubber or plastic soles, and should first
eliminate any static charges by touching the transmitter rack with both hands.
a) Switch off both transmitters: set the TX1 and TX2 switches on the PMM to OFF.
b) Release the MSG-C resp. MSP or CSL with the lever mechanism and remove it from the slide-in
chassis in the rack. Lay the subassembly down on an electronically conductive surface (e.g. on
the special packaging provided).
c) Remove the EPROM:
Identify the EPROM to be replaced by means of its inscription and note its orientation (notch on
one of the narrow sides). Lever the EPROM slowly out of the base by carefully applying a flat,
pointed object (e.g. a screwdriver) to the narrow sides alternately.
d) Fit the new EPROM:
Fit the new EPROM into the empty base in the same position. If the EPROM is swapped from one
unit to another, determine the correct orientation by comparing the two units. Before fitting the
EPROM, check that all the pins are aligned exactly. Press the two rows of pins into the base one
at a time.
e) Reinstall the MSG-C resp. MSP or CSL and lock it in position.
f) Execute the following checks after switching on the transmitter again:
- the live LED must light up (MSG-C, MSP)
- create new EPROM checksum for monitor 1 and 2 (refer to 6.2.3.2.2 .
- all the transmitter and monitor settings must correspond to test reports.
6.2.3.2.2 Creating new Checksum for MSP EPROM in ADRACS

Change of EPROM on MSP makes it necessary to create a new EPROM checksum:


- Select the station where the EPROM of MSP is changed.
- Select in Menus the item ...Monitor Transmitter CSB Data.
- Select in Tools the item commands. The Monitor Commands window appears.
- Click soft button change group and select the command Create EPROM checksum in the
Monitor Miscellaneous window.
- Click soft button program MON-1/2 to create the new checksum.
- Close the window and go back to the Main Status Menu.

Ed. 01.02 6-19


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance

6.2.3.2.3 Replace and Reconfigure Subassembly LCP


Before starting any replacement it is recommend to read out all parameters of the installation: Use
command Download Parameters or make a printout of all parameters or write down manually the indiĆ
cated parameters if other measures are not possible. It is also recommended to generate a copy of
the specific site files as backup:
- Click the control button in the main status window in the PC User Program.
- Select File Transfer and Copy site file to PC in the submenu.
- Copy all files with the extension:*.sit, *.oio, *.msk, *.ptt.
The LCP subassembly contains routines which allow to check the LCP hardware and to configure
the LCP to the system ILS 420 or CVOR/DVOR.
The spare subassembly LCP is not configured to a specific subsystem (i.e. ILS 420 or CVOR/DVOR).
This is to be done restarting the subsystem with power on:
a) To start the special function menu press buttons 1 and 4 simultaneously on the LCP immediately
after power on and hold pressed until screen of LCP contains menu information.
b) Select one of the upcoming menu points, here for CVOR 431: Configure CVOR 431. The LCP copĆ
ies, renames or deletes some files according to the selected systems. This menu point does not
appear again when the selection has been done once.
Finishing this procedure the LCP is ready. Further configuration is to be done with the ADRACS user
program.

LCP Control Menu Factory use only:

ALARM used for factory test


S1 Test the LCP board used to delete bad or wrong
S2 Delete drive d: .sit-files on drive d: of LCP
WARNING S3 Restore REU.exe saving reu.exe update REU
S4 Secure REU.exe firmware
S1+S2 not used in CVOR
NORMAL S1+S3 Configure CVOR 431 select LCP use
S1+S2 Exit to DOS Exit control menu to standard

REMOTE

LOCAL

MAINTENANCE

control buttons (S) 1 2 3 4

Fig. 6-3 LCP front panel and LCP control menu

6.2.3.3 CVOR Antenna

A large number of settings must usually be re-made after replacing the CVOR antenna, the CVOR
matching device or the CVOR monitor dipole. If the CVOR antenna is replaced, a special flight test
is also necessary.

6-20 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs
6.2.4 List of DIP-FIX-Switches and Jumpers
6.2.4.1 General

Some of the subassemblies have DIP-FIX switches or jumpers on the component side. The jumpers
act either as on/off switches or as changeover switches. The DIP-FIX switches and jumpers can be
set or placed to particular positions in order to adapt universal subassemblies to specific equipment
types. Other switches or jumpers must be actuated for test and maintenance purposes, or in case
of interconnection with a DME. Under normal climatic conditions it is not necessary to solder the
DIP-FIX switches in their limit positions.

NOTE: Before installing a spare subassembly check and correct if necessary position of the DIP-
FIX switches and jumpers.

Overview of subassemblies containing DIP-FIX switches and jumpers:

No. Subassembly Short name Reference number


1 Control and Selector Logic CSL 83135 23100

2 Modulation Signal Generator Control MSG-C 83135 27200

3 Monitor Signal Processor MSP-VD 83135 22300

4 Local Control Panel LCP:


- Local Control Interface LCI 83135 21301
- Local Control CPU LC-CPU 83135 21402

5 Voice amplifier VAM 83131 71701

6 Backpanel Transmitter BP-T 58351 00210

NOTE: The position of the DIP-FIX switches and jumpers for the modem subassemblies will be
found in the Technical Manual for Remote Control RCSE-443 (Ref.No. 83140 5 5322).

Ed. 01.02 6-21


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance

6-22 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs

X14
V33
X13
S4

S3

V34

S2

S1 EPROM
S6 D10

V28
X17* X15
EPROM
V27 D9 X24X23

X12

X11
ASSOC.

X5
X6

X7
X8
S5
IND.

3 2 1

2
X3 X25

user defined
X4 voltage adjust optionally to
X19,20,21
X19 between 1.7 to 1.875 X26
X20 X18
X21 R X22
P3 P4

set open set * set with ILS


open
1 2 3

SWITCH POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


S1, S3 key Manual switch off TX1 or TX2
S2, S4 key Manual switch on TX1 or TX2
S5 lower Independent, DME = Master (2-3, 5-6) Slide switch for DME/TACAN-
identity interface, depends on
upper Associated, AN400 = Master (1-3, 4-6) installation
S6 0...F Test signal select
JUMPER POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS
X7,X8,X11 Signal definition and drive select Morse code signal for DME
X7, X8 1-2 positive logic: device on = current flow Normal operation

2-3 negative logic: device on = no current flow


X5,X6,X12 Signal definition and drive select to DME: Station Operational
X5, X6 1-2 positive logic: device on = current flow Normal operation

2-3 negative logic: device on = no current flow


X9,X10 not existing
X11, X12 1-2 Drive using Darlington current source Normal operation

2-3 Drive using optocoupler only


1 Control and Selector Logic (CSL) 83135 23100 1 of 2

Ed. 01.02 6-23


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance

JUMPER POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


X13 set Switch off line TX1 from LCP default setting

open Interrupt Switch off line TX1 from LCP


X14 set Switch off line TX2 from LCP default setting

open Interrupt Switch off line TX2 from LCP


X15 set Line OP_IN- from DME default setting

open Interrupt line OP_IN- from DME


X16 not existing
X17 set Test signal selection, ILS default setting ILS

open Test signal selection, VOR/DVOR default setting (D)VOR


X18 set Enabling cutoff for over-discharge protection Emergency battery operation

open without over-discharge protection Operation without emergency


battery or function disabled
X19,29,21 Selection of battery type/cell voltage only one jumper set simultan.!
X19 set battery switch off at 1,7 V/cell alternate to X20, X21

open
X20 set battery switch off at 1,8 V/cell alternate to X19, X21

open
X21 set battery switch off at 1,875 V/cell default setting

open
X22 set enabling automatic restore with PMM-5 and (D)VOR
(power management)
open - with PMM-5 and ILS
X23 set no monitor fault monitoring MON2

open monitor fault monitoring MON2 default setting


X24 set no monitor fault monitoring MON1

open monitor fault monitoring MON1 default setting


X25 1-2 DME-Status is transmitted via remote contr.
depends on DME-Interface
2-3 DME-Status is transmitted via signalling line
OP_IN+ and OP_IN-
X26 set On/off line to optocoupler interface of BCPS Default setting
from LCP via CSL closed (Power Management)

open On/off line to optocoupler interface of BCPS depends on installation


from LCP via CSL open, e.g. if no emergency
battery exists
1 Control and Selector Logic (CSL) 83135 23100 2 of 2

6-24 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs

X7
- + -
X8 X4
battery 3.6 V

V2
V3

X6
3 2 1

EPROM
D8

EPROM
D7

X5
3 2 1

S1

V4

set open set


open
1 2 3

JUMPER POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


X4 set watch-dog fault triggers NMI
(Non Maskable Interrupt)

open NMI function disabled default setting


X5 2-3 EPROM type 27C040 default setting

1-2 EPROM type 27C020


X6 1-2 RAM type 628128 default setting

2-3 RAM-Typ 628512


X7 set backup battery switched on default setting

open backup battery switched off


X8 set multiple reset disabled, if watch dog fails

open multiple reset enabled default setting


2 Modulation Signal Generator Control (MSG-C) 83135 27200

Ed. 01.02 6-25


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance

X5 X6
V2 1 2 3 1 2 3
V3
V1 X7 EPROM
D7

EPROM
X22 X8 D8

S1
- + -

battery 3.6 V

X28
V4

X12 X3

X25

set open set


open
1 2 3

JUMPER POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


X3 for factory adjustment only, a solder strip is inserted
onto the soldering side after adjustment
X5 1-2 EPROM type 27C020 or 27C040

2-3 EPROM type 27C040 with complete decoding default setting


X6 1-2 RAM type 628128 default setting

2-3 RAM-Typ 628512


X7 set the RAM is battery buffered, i.e. the system parameter, default setting
alarm storage and operating hours are maintained
after system switch off

open RAM is not battery buffered, i.e. the above mentioned


data will be lost after system switch off
X8 set multiple reset disabled, if watch dog timer fails

open multiple reset enabled default setting


X12 audio socket for listening to voice signals e.g. station
identity, meteorological data (ATIS)
3 Monitor Signal Processor (MSP-VD) 83135 22300 1 of 2

6-26 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs

JUMPER POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


X22 set watch dog fault triggers NMI, i.e. when the
processor has a fail function, the processor
monitoring circuit leaves out one interrupt

open NM function disabled default setting


X25 feed in point for GND
X28 set default setting

open factory adjustment


3 Monitor Signal Processor (MSP-VD) 83135 22300 2 of 2

Ed. 01.02 6-27


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance

OIO-IN
LC-CPU COM5 CSL, COM9..10 OIO-OUT DME/NDB COM1...7

X8,9,11..14
X37

X38
X39
DME/NDB

X34 X33

S1
X6 X2 X51 X52 X1
876543 21 * *
OFF
ON
1
optionally, normally not assembled

CPU X84 X83 X82 X81 1


X60 board B1 A1
RS422 only RS422/485
1

1 1
B10 X99 B1
X48 LCI rear DME/NDB
1 A1

PC-1
X15 COM4 Key lock Power COM8
X35 Supply
X25...32 X50
+ *
X95 R1
X5
B10 B1
1
X5 X6 X7 X8 X9
1
X4
Battery X41 local
A1
2 GND
3.6 V 3 lock
X4 1
0.8 Ah H1 Brightness
X36
1 COM3
Life LED X24
-15 V +5 V DGND
1 1 X100*
S2 X10* X53* X16...23 1
X55 X56 X54
Keyboard Printer Ethernet
Reset CPU
RS422/485

recessed opening
in LC-CPU board
RS232

1 RS232
COM4 2 TTL
* optional 3 RS422/
1
2
3

X9 RS485 X81 to 84
X32
X31
X30
X29
X28
X27
X26
X25

IAUX set to
1 X11 GND +5V ext.
2
set X12 B1 A1 B1 A1

3 open COM5 X13 B2 A2 B2 A2


1 RS232
B3 A3 B3 A3
X14 2 TTL
set COM3 B4 A4 B4 A4
X8 3 RS422/ B5 A5 B5 A5
open RS485
RS485 RS422
X23
X22
X21
X20
X19
X18
X17
X16

B6 A6 B6 A6

JUMPER POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


bank X81 A1-B1/B2-B3 IAUX14 active low default setting
B1-B2/A3-B3 IAUX14 active high

A4-B4/B5-B6 IAUX15 active low default setting


B4-B5/A6-B6 IAUX15 active high
bank X82 A1-B1/B2-B3 IAUX12 active low default setting
B1-B2/A3-B3 IAUX12 active high

A4-B4/B5-B6 IAUX13 active low default setting


B4-B5/A6-B6 IAUX13 active high
bank X83 A1-B1/B2-B3 IAUX11 active low default setting
B1-B2/A3-B3 IAUX11 active high

A4-B4/B5-B6 IAUX10 active low default setting


B4-B5/A6-B6 IAUX10 active high
4 Local Control Panel (LCP: LC-CPU/LCI) 83135 21402 / 83135 21301 1 of 3

6-28 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs

JUMPER POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


bank X84 A1-B1/B2-B3 IAUX9 active low default setting
B1-B2/A3-B3 IAUX9 active high

A4-B4/B5-B6 IAUX8 active low default setting


B4-B5/A6-B6 IAUX8 active high
X95 A1-B1, ... , A8-B8 serial port3 set to RS232 Port 3 (COM3)
X25...X32 1-2

X24, X41 not used -


X95 B1-B2, B3-B4 ,B5-B6, B7-B8 serial port3 set to TTL
X25/26 2-2
X27/28 2-2
X29/30 2-2
X31/32 2-2

X24, X41 not used -


X95 A1-B1, ... , A8-B8 serial port3 set to RS422
X25...X32 2-3

X24 2-3 full duplex default setting


X41 open -
X95 A1-B1, ... , A10-B10 serial port3 set to RS485
X25...32 2-3

X24 1-2 half duplex default; signal RTS controls


TX enable in UART mode
X41 set adds 100 W termination
X99 A1-B1, ... , A8-B8 serial port4 set to RS232 Port 4 (COM4)
X16...23 1-2

X15, X40 not used -


X99 B1-B2, B3-B4 ,B5-B6, B7-B8 serial port4 set to TTL
X16/17 2-2
X18/19 2-2
X20/21 2-2
X22/23 2-2

X15, X40 not used -


X99 A1-B1, ... , A8-B8 serial port4 set to RS422
X16...23 2-3

X15 2-3 full duplex default setting


X40 open -
X99 A1-B1, ... , A10-B10 serial port4 set to RS485
X16...23 2-3

X15 1-2 half duplex default; signal RTS controls


TX enable in UART mode
X40 set adds 100 W termination
4 Local Control Panel (LCP: LC-CPU/LCI) 83135 21402 / 83135 21301 2 of 3

Ed. 01.02 6-29


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance

JUMPER POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


X38,39 open serial port5 set to RS232 Port 5 (COM5)
X9,11...14 1-2

X8/X37 not used -


X38,39 open serial port5 set to RS422
X9,11...14 2-3

X8 2-3 full duplex default setting


X37 open -
X38,39 set serial port5 set to RS485
X9,11...14 2-3

X8 1-2 half duplex default; signal RTS controls


TX enable in UART mode
X37 set adds 100 W termination

X33 open serial port1 set to RS232, IRQ14 pathed to CPU


interrupt path
set not used
X34 set serial port5 set to RS232, IRQ6 pathed to CPU
RS422/485, interrupt path
open for ext. device test
X35 set watch dog on if enabled by software

open watch dog off


X36 set battery backup enabled used for RTC on CPU

open battery backup disabled RTC not buffered


S1 input register 6 Bit 4...7: (optional assembly)

S1/8 on Bit 4 to GND Bypass not auto-disabled


off - default setting
S1/7 on Bit 5 to GND not used
off - default setting
S1/6 on Bit 6 to GND not used
off - TX1 ON, Status
S1/5 on Bit 7 to GND not used
off - TX2 ON, Status
S1/1 to 4 off IN0...IN3 always off, on not allowed
LCI rear
X5 1-2 Font select: 40 characters default setting
2-3 Font select: 30 characters
X6 1-2 Font select: per HW (X5) default setting
2-3 Font select: per SW
X7 1-2 Display allways on default setting
2-3 Display off/on per SW
X8 1-2 spare default setting
2-3 not used
X9 1-2 Buzzer on default setting
2-3 Buzzer off
4 Local Control Panel (LCP: LC-CPU/LCI) 83135 21402 / 83135 21301 3 of 3

6-30 Ed. 01.02


CVOR 431
Operation and Maintenance Repairs

S4
R33

S2
S3
S1

4
2 1
On/Off switch Change-over switch

DIP-FIX POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


SWITCH
S1, S2, S3 on signal path closed normal operation

off signal path opened between filĆ factory adjustment


ters for measurement
S4 2-1 signal path closed normal operation

2-4 signal path opened for comparaĆ factory adjustment


tor test

5 Voice Amplifier (VAM), option 83131 71701

Ed. 01.02 6-31


CVOR 431
Repairs Operation and Maintenance

Ê
Ê Ê
Ê
Ê Ê
X87 X86 X79 X78
X85 X82
X94 X93 X92

Ê Ê
X80

Ê Ê
X99 X98 X97 X96 X77 X76 X84
X73

Ê Ê
BP-C X74
X83

Ê Ê
X95 -3 - 1
X72 X71 -4 - 2 1 1

Ê Ê
50W TX2
2 2
100W 3 3 TX1

Ê Ê
X84 X81

Ê Ê
1 1
50W TX2
2 2
100W TX1

Ê Ê
3 3
X70 X82
BP-T X71 X84 X83

Ê Ê
X81
1
X83 TX2
(TX1) X72 2

Ê Ê
X85 X82 TX1 3
X80
X85

Ê Ê
1
TX2
2
Setting example: 100 W, TX1
TX1

Ê Ê
3
CA-100/1* 1 1
50W TX2

Ê Ê
X80 2 2
100W 3 3 TX1

Ê Ê
X84 X81
X70
BP-T X71 X84
50W
1 1
TX2

Ê Ê
X81
2 2
X83 TX1
X72 100W 3 3
(TX2)

Ê Ê
X85 X82
X80 X83 X82

1 1

Ê Ê
TX2 TX2
2 2
TX1 3 TX1 3

Ê Ê
X85

X80 Setting example: 100 W, TX2


* 100 W only

Jumper POSITION DEFINITION REMARKS


X80 1-2 TX2 Definition of TX1 or TX2
2-3 TX1
X84, X83 1-2 50W Settings for 50 W, TX1
X85 2-3 TX1
X81 2-3 TX1
X82 2-3 TX1
X84, X83 2-3 100W Settings for 100 W, TX1
X85 2-3 TX1
X81 2-3 TX1
X82 2-3 TX1
X84, X83 1-2 50W Settings for 50 W, TX2
X85 1-2 TX2
X81 1-2 TX2
X82 1-2 TX2
X84,X83 2-3 100W Settings for 100 W, TX2
X85 1-2 TX2
X81 1-2 TX2
X82 1-2 TX2
6 Backpanel Transmitter (BP-T) 58351 00210

6-32 Ed. 01.02

You might also like